Mercurial > emacs
annotate src/dispnew.c @ 36262:c2f7a7dc3322
(make-coding-system): Doc fixes.
author | Dave Love <fx@gnu.org> |
---|---|
date | Wed, 21 Feb 2001 14:58:35 +0000 |
parents | c0fac212cfcc |
children | 1e3dc8692936 |
rev | line source |
---|---|
314 | 1 /* Updating of data structures for redisplay. |
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
2 Copyright (C) 1985, 86, 87, 88, 93, 94, 95, 97, 98, 1999, 2000 |
18853
4501a367a887
(direct_output_forward_char): Reenable check against
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18774
diff
changeset
|
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
314 | 4 |
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs. | |
6 | |
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify | |
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by | |
1777
4edfaa19c7a7
* window.c (window_internal_width): New function.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1766
diff
changeset
|
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) |
314 | 10 any later version. |
11 | |
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | |
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | |
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the | |
15 GNU General Public License for more details. | |
16 | |
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | |
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to | |
14186
ee40177f6c68
Update FSF's address in the preamble.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
14125
diff
changeset
|
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, |
ee40177f6c68
Update FSF's address in the preamble.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
14125
diff
changeset
|
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ |
314 | 21 |
26088
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
22 #include <config.h> |
314 | 23 #include <signal.h> |
7900
60795e826dad
Put stdio.h after config.h.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7814
diff
changeset
|
24 #include <stdio.h> |
314 | 25 #include <ctype.h> |
26 | |
21514 | 27 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H |
28 #include <unistd.h> | |
29 #endif | |
30 | |
3525
58e789baa27a
Include lisp.h earlier (before termhooks.h).
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3517
diff
changeset
|
31 #include "lisp.h" |
314 | 32 #include "termchar.h" |
33 #include "termopts.h" | |
2198 | 34 #include "termhooks.h" |
13526
34382f4e23cb
Always include dispextern.h before cm.h.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13448
diff
changeset
|
35 /* cm.h must come after dispextern.h on Windows. */ |
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
36 #include "dispextern.h" |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
37 #include "cm.h" |
314 | 38 #include "buffer.h" |
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
39 #include "charset.h" |
31093
6da961dff718
Include keyboard.h before frame.h.
Andrew Innes <andrewi@gnu.org>
parents:
30720
diff
changeset
|
40 #include "keyboard.h" |
764 | 41 #include "frame.h" |
314 | 42 #include "window.h" |
43 #include "commands.h" | |
44 #include "disptab.h" | |
45 #include "indent.h" | |
4384
98605d0ea3cf
(direct_output_for_insert): Fail if character
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
4290
diff
changeset
|
46 #include "intervals.h" |
15065 | 47 #include "blockinput.h" |
21514 | 48 #include "process.h" |
314 | 49 |
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
50 /* I don't know why DEC Alpha OSF1 fail to compile this file if we |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
51 include the following file. */ |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
52 /* #include "systty.h" */ |
12917 | 53 #include "syssignal.h" |
554 | 54 |
314 | 55 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS |
56 #include "xterm.h" | |
25012 | 57 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */ |
314 | 58 |
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
59 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
60 #include "w32term.h" |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
61 #endif /* HAVE_NTGUI */ |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
62 |
32752
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
63 #ifdef macintosh |
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
64 #include "macterm.h" |
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
65 #endif /* macintosh */ |
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
66 |
25012 | 67 /* Include systime.h after xterm.h to avoid double inclusion of time.h. */ |
68 | |
7808
52e2eb6245d4
Include systime.h after xterm.h.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7648
diff
changeset
|
69 #include "systime.h" |
7558
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
70 #include <errno.h> |
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
71 |
25012 | 72 /* To get the prototype for `sleep'. */ |
73 | |
74 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H | |
75 #include <unistd.h> | |
76 #endif | |
77 | |
314 | 78 #define max(a, b) ((a) > (b) ? (a) : (b)) |
79 #define min(a, b) ((a) < (b) ? (a) : (b)) | |
80 | |
81 /* Get number of chars of output now in the buffer of a stdio stream. | |
25012 | 82 This ought to be built in in stdio, but it isn't. Some s- files |
83 override this because their stdio internals differ. */ | |
84 | |
5214
c4bf07b226be
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT) [__GNU_LIBRARY__]: Alternate definition for the GNU
Roland McGrath <roland@gnu.org>
parents:
5083
diff
changeset
|
85 #ifdef __GNU_LIBRARY__ |
25012 | 86 |
87 /* The s- file might have overridden the definition with one that | |
88 works for the system's C library. But we are using the GNU C | |
89 library, so this is the right definition for every system. */ | |
90 | |
7558
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
91 #ifdef GNU_LIBRARY_PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT |
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
92 #define PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT GNU_LIBRARY_PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT |
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
93 #else |
7443
a9cb818e5316
[__GNU_LIBRARY__]: Redefine PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT even if already defined.
Roland McGrath <roland@gnu.org>
parents:
7247
diff
changeset
|
94 #undef PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT |
5214
c4bf07b226be
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT) [__GNU_LIBRARY__]: Alternate definition for the GNU
Roland McGrath <roland@gnu.org>
parents:
5083
diff
changeset
|
95 #define PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT(FILE) ((FILE)->__bufp - (FILE)->__buffer) |
7558
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
96 #endif |
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
97 #else /* not __GNU_LIBRARY__ */ |
26088
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
98 #if !defined (PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT) && HAVE_STDIO_EXT_H && HAVE___FPENDING |
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
99 #include <stdio_ext.h> |
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
100 #define PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT(FILE) __fpending (FILE) |
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
101 #endif |
7443
a9cb818e5316
[__GNU_LIBRARY__]: Redefine PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT even if already defined.
Roland McGrath <roland@gnu.org>
parents:
7247
diff
changeset
|
102 #ifndef PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT |
314 | 103 #define PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT(FILE) ((FILE)->_ptr - (FILE)->_base) |
104 #endif | |
25012 | 105 #endif /* not __GNU_LIBRARY__ */ |
106 | |
29437 | 107 #if defined (LINUX) && defined (HAVE_LIBNCURSES) |
108 #include <term.h> /* for tgetent */ | |
109 #endif | |
25012 | 110 |
111 /* Structure to pass dimensions around. Used for character bounding | |
112 boxes, glyph matrix dimensions and alike. */ | |
113 | |
114 struct dim | |
115 { | |
116 int width; | |
117 int height; | |
118 }; | |
119 | |
120 | |
121 /* Function prototypes. */ | |
122 | |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
123 static struct glyph_matrix *save_current_matrix P_ ((struct frame *)); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
124 static void restore_current_matrix P_ ((struct frame *, struct glyph_matrix *)); |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
125 static void fake_current_matrices P_ ((Lisp_Object)); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
126 static void redraw_overlapping_rows P_ ((struct window *, int)); |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
127 static void redraw_overlapped_rows P_ ((struct window *, int)); |
25012 | 128 static int count_blanks P_ ((struct glyph *, int)); |
129 static int count_match P_ ((struct glyph *, struct glyph *, | |
130 struct glyph *, struct glyph *)); | |
131 static unsigned line_draw_cost P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, int)); | |
132 static void update_frame_line P_ ((struct frame *, int)); | |
133 static struct dim allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay | |
134 P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, struct dim, int, int *)); | |
135 static void allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay P_ ((struct window *, | |
136 struct dim)); | |
137 static int realloc_glyph_pool P_ ((struct glyph_pool *, struct dim)); | |
138 static void adjust_frame_glyphs P_ ((struct frame *)); | |
139 struct glyph_matrix *new_glyph_matrix P_ ((struct glyph_pool *)); | |
140 static void free_glyph_matrix P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *)); | |
141 static void adjust_glyph_matrix P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_matrix *, | |
142 int, int, struct dim)); | |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
143 static void change_frame_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int, int)); |
25012 | 144 static void swap_glyph_pointers P_ ((struct glyph_row *, struct glyph_row *)); |
34895
53e52b3525bf
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34893
diff
changeset
|
145 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
25012 | 146 static int glyph_row_slice_p P_ ((struct glyph_row *, struct glyph_row *)); |
30323
4cd1b8fe118c
(direct_output_for_insert): Remove confusing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30307
diff
changeset
|
147 #endif |
25012 | 148 static void fill_up_frame_row_with_spaces P_ ((struct glyph_row *, int)); |
149 static void build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, | |
150 struct window *)); | |
151 static void build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, | |
152 struct window *)); | |
153 static struct glyph_pool *new_glyph_pool P_ ((void)); | |
154 static void free_glyph_pool P_ ((struct glyph_pool *)); | |
155 static void adjust_frame_glyphs_initially P_ ((void)); | |
156 static void adjust_frame_message_buffer P_ ((struct frame *)); | |
157 static void adjust_decode_mode_spec_buffer P_ ((struct frame *)); | |
158 static void fill_up_glyph_row_with_spaces P_ ((struct glyph_row *)); | |
159 static void build_frame_matrix P_ ((struct frame *)); | |
160 void clear_current_matrices P_ ((struct frame *)); | |
161 void scroll_glyph_matrix_range P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, int, int, | |
162 int, int)); | |
163 static void clear_window_matrices P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
164 static void fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces P_ ((struct glyph_row *, int)); | |
165 static int scrolling_window P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
166 static int update_window_line P_ ((struct window *, int, int *)); |
25012 | 167 static void update_marginal_area P_ ((struct window *, int, int)); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
168 static int update_text_area P_ ((struct window *, int)); |
25012 | 169 static void make_current P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, struct glyph_matrix *, |
170 int)); | |
171 static void mirror_make_current P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
172 void check_window_matrix_pointers P_ ((struct window *)); | |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
173 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
25012 | 174 static void check_matrix_pointers P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, |
175 struct glyph_matrix *)); | |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
176 #endif |
25012 | 177 static void mirror_line_dance P_ ((struct window *, int, int, int *, char *)); |
178 static int update_window_tree P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
179 static int update_window P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
180 static int update_frame_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int)); | |
181 static void set_window_cursor_after_update P_ ((struct window *)); | |
182 static int row_equal_p P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, | |
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
183 struct glyph_row *, int)); |
25012 | 184 static void adjust_frame_glyphs_for_window_redisplay P_ ((struct frame *)); |
185 static void adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay P_ ((struct frame *)); | |
186 static void reverse_rows P_ ((struct glyph_matrix *, int, int)); | |
187 static int margin_glyphs_to_reserve P_ ((struct window *, int, Lisp_Object)); | |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
188 static void sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows P_ ((struct window *)); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
189 struct window *frame_row_to_window P_ ((struct window *, int)); |
25012 | 190 |
191 | |
192 /* Non-zero means don't pause redisplay for pending input. (This is | |
193 for debugging and for a future implementation of EDT-like | |
194 scrolling. */ | |
195 | |
196 int redisplay_dont_pause; | |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
197 |
554 | 198 /* Nonzero upon entry to redisplay means do not assume anything about |
764 | 199 current contents of actual terminal frame; clear and redraw it. */ |
314 | 200 |
764 | 201 int frame_garbaged; |
314 | 202 |
25012 | 203 /* Nonzero means last display completed. Zero means it was preempted. */ |
314 | 204 |
205 int display_completed; | |
206 | |
25012 | 207 /* Lisp variable visible-bell; enables use of screen-flash instead of |
208 audible bell. */ | |
314 | 209 |
210 int visible_bell; | |
211 | |
764 | 212 /* Invert the color of the whole frame, at a low level. */ |
314 | 213 |
214 int inverse_video; | |
215 | |
216 /* Line speed of the terminal. */ | |
217 | |
218 int baud_rate; | |
219 | |
25012 | 220 /* Either nil or a symbol naming the window system under which Emacs |
221 is running. */ | |
314 | 222 |
223 Lisp_Object Vwindow_system; | |
224 | |
225 /* Version number of X windows: 10, 11 or nil. */ | |
25012 | 226 |
314 | 227 Lisp_Object Vwindow_system_version; |
228 | |
25012 | 229 /* Vector of glyph definitions. Indexed by glyph number, the contents |
230 are a string which is how to output the glyph. | |
314 | 231 |
232 If Vglyph_table is nil, a glyph is output by using its low 8 bits | |
25012 | 233 as a character code. |
234 | |
235 This is an obsolete feature that is no longer used. The variable | |
236 is retained for compatibility. */ | |
314 | 237 |
238 Lisp_Object Vglyph_table; | |
239 | |
240 /* Display table to use for vectors that don't specify their own. */ | |
241 | |
242 Lisp_Object Vstandard_display_table; | |
243 | |
25012 | 244 /* Nonzero means reading single-character input with prompt so put |
245 cursor on mini-buffer after the prompt. positive means at end of | |
246 text in echo area; negative means at beginning of line. */ | |
247 | |
314 | 248 int cursor_in_echo_area; |
13220
2e9014617492
(Qdisplay_table): New variable.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13105
diff
changeset
|
249 |
30720
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
250 Lisp_Object Qdisplay_table, Qredisplay_dont_pause; |
25012 | 251 |
314 | 252 |
25012 | 253 /* The currently selected frame. In a single-frame version, this |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
254 variable always equals the_only_frame. */ |
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
255 |
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
256 Lisp_Object selected_frame; |
25012 | 257 |
258 /* A frame which is not just a mini-buffer, or 0 if there are no such | |
764 | 259 frames. This is usually the most recent such frame that was |
9572 | 260 selected. In a single-frame version, this variable always holds |
261 the address of the_only_frame. */ | |
25012 | 262 |
263 struct frame *last_nonminibuf_frame; | |
264 | |
265 /* Stdio stream being used for copy of all output. */ | |
266 | |
267 FILE *termscript; | |
268 | |
269 /* Structure for info on cursor positioning. */ | |
270 | |
271 struct cm Wcm; | |
272 | |
273 /* 1 means SIGWINCH happened when not safe. */ | |
274 | |
275 int delayed_size_change; | |
276 | |
277 /* 1 means glyph initialization has been completed at startup. */ | |
278 | |
279 static int glyphs_initialized_initially_p; | |
280 | |
281 /* Updated window if != 0. Set by update_window. */ | |
282 | |
283 struct window *updated_window; | |
284 | |
285 /* Glyph row updated in update_window_line, and area that is updated. */ | |
286 | |
287 struct glyph_row *updated_row; | |
288 int updated_area; | |
289 | |
290 /* A glyph for a space. */ | |
291 | |
292 struct glyph space_glyph; | |
293 | |
294 /* Non-zero means update has been performed directly, so that there's | |
295 no need for redisplay_internal to do much work. Set by | |
296 direct_output_for_insert. */ | |
297 | |
298 int redisplay_performed_directly_p; | |
299 | |
300 /* Counts of allocated structures. These counts serve to diagnose | |
301 memory leaks and double frees. */ | |
302 | |
303 int glyph_matrix_count; | |
304 int glyph_pool_count; | |
305 | |
306 /* If non-null, the frame whose frame matrices are manipulated. If | |
307 null, window matrices are worked on. */ | |
308 | |
309 static struct frame *frame_matrix_frame; | |
310 | |
311 /* Current interface for window-based redisplay. Set from init_xterm. | |
312 A null value means we are not using window-based redisplay. */ | |
313 | |
314 struct redisplay_interface *rif; | |
315 | |
316 /* Non-zero means that fonts have been loaded since the last glyph | |
317 matrix adjustments. Redisplay must stop, and glyph matrices must | |
318 be adjusted when this flag becomes non-zero during display. The | |
319 reason fonts can be loaded so late is that fonts of fontsets are | |
320 loaded on demand. */ | |
321 | |
322 int fonts_changed_p; | |
323 | |
324 /* Convert vpos and hpos from frame to window and vice versa. | |
325 This may only be used for terminal frames. */ | |
326 | |
327 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
328 | |
329 static int window_to_frame_vpos P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
330 static int window_to_frame_hpos P_ ((struct window *, int)); | |
331 #define WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS(W, VPOS) window_to_frame_vpos ((W), (VPOS)) | |
332 #define WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS(W, HPOS) window_to_frame_hpos ((W), (HPOS)) | |
333 | |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
334 /* One element of the ring buffer containing redisplay history |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
335 information. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
336 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
337 struct redisplay_history |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
338 { |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
339 char trace[512 + 100]; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
340 }; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
341 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
342 /* The size of the history buffer. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
343 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
344 #define REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE 30 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
345 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
346 /* The redisplay history buffer. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
347 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
348 static struct redisplay_history redisplay_history[REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE]; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
349 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
350 /* Next free entry in redisplay_history. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
351 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
352 static int history_idx; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
353 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
354 /* A tick that's incremented each time something is added to the |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
355 history. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
356 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
357 static unsigned history_tick; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
358 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
359 static void add_frame_display_history P_ ((struct frame *, int)); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
360 static void add_window_display_history P_ ((struct window *, char *, int)); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
361 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
362 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
363 /* Add to the redisplay history how window W has been displayed. |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
364 MSG is a trace containing the information how W's glyph matrix |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
365 has been contructed. PAUSED_P non-zero means that the update |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
366 has been interrupted for pending input. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
367 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
368 static void |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
369 add_window_display_history (w, msg, paused_p) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
370 struct window *w; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
371 char *msg; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
372 int paused_p; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
373 { |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
374 char *buf; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
375 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
376 if (history_idx >= REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
377 history_idx = 0; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
378 buf = redisplay_history[history_idx].trace; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
379 ++history_idx; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
380 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
381 sprintf (buf, "%d: window %p (`%s')%s\n", |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
382 history_tick++, |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
383 w, |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
384 ((BUFFERP (w->buffer) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
385 && STRINGP (XBUFFER (w->buffer)->name)) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
386 ? (char *) XSTRING (XBUFFER (w->buffer)->name)->data |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
387 : "???"), |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
388 paused_p ? " ***paused***" : ""); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
389 strcat (buf, msg); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
390 } |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
391 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
392 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
393 /* Add to the redisplay history that frame F has been displayed. |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
394 PAUSED_P non-zero means that the update has been interrupted for |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
395 pending input. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
396 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
397 static void |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
398 add_frame_display_history (f, paused_p) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
399 struct frame *f; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
400 int paused_p; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
401 { |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
402 char *buf; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
403 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
404 if (history_idx >= REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
405 history_idx = 0; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
406 buf = redisplay_history[history_idx].trace; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
407 ++history_idx; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
408 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
409 sprintf (buf, "%d: update frame %p%s", |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
410 history_tick++, |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
411 f, paused_p ? " ***paused***" : ""); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
412 } |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
413 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
414 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
415 DEFUN ("dump-redisplay-history", Fdump_redisplay_history, |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
416 Sdump_redisplay_history, 0, 0, "", |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
417 "Dump redisplay history to stderr.") |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
418 () |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
419 { |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
420 int i; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
421 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
422 for (i = history_idx - 1; i != history_idx; --i) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
423 { |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
424 if (i < 0) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
425 i = REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE - 1; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
426 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", redisplay_history[i].trace); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
427 } |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
428 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
429 return Qnil; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
430 } |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
431 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
432 |
25012 | 433 #else /* GLYPH_DEBUG == 0 */ |
434 | |
435 #define WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS(W, VPOS) ((VPOS) + XFASTINT ((W)->top)) | |
436 #define WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS(W, HPOS) ((HPOS) + XFASTINT ((W)->left)) | |
437 | |
438 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG == 0 */ | |
439 | |
440 | |
441 /* Like bcopy except never gets confused by overlap. Let this be the | |
442 first function defined in this file, or change emacs.c where the | |
443 address of this function is used. */ | |
314 | 444 |
445 void | |
446 safe_bcopy (from, to, size) | |
447 char *from, *to; | |
448 int size; | |
449 { | |
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
450 if (size <= 0 || from == to) |
314 | 451 return; |
452 | |
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
453 /* If the source and destination don't overlap, then bcopy can |
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
454 handle it. If they do overlap, but the destination is lower in |
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
455 memory than the source, we'll assume bcopy can handle that. */ |
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
456 if (to < from || from + size <= to) |
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
457 bcopy (from, to, size); |
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
458 |
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
459 /* Otherwise, we'll copy from the end. */ |
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
460 else |
314 | 461 { |
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
462 register char *endf = from + size; |
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
463 register char *endt = to + size; |
314 | 464 |
465 /* If TO - FROM is large, then we should break the copy into | |
466 nonoverlapping chunks of TO - FROM bytes each. However, if | |
467 TO - FROM is small, then the bcopy function call overhead | |
468 makes this not worth it. The crossover point could be about | |
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
469 anywhere. Since I don't think the obvious copy loop is too |
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
470 bad, I'm trying to err in its favor. */ |
314 | 471 if (to - from < 64) |
472 { | |
473 do | |
474 *--endt = *--endf; | |
475 while (endf != from); | |
476 } | |
477 else | |
478 { | |
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
479 for (;;) |
314 | 480 { |
481 endt -= (to - from); | |
482 endf -= (to - from); | |
483 | |
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
484 if (endt < to) |
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
485 break; |
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
486 |
314 | 487 bcopy (endf, endt, to - from); |
488 } | |
1588
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
489 |
732a88db381f
* dispnew.c [not MULTI_FRAME] (Fredraw_display): Pass the correct
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1495
diff
changeset
|
490 /* If SIZE wasn't a multiple of TO - FROM, there will be a |
25012 | 491 little left over. The amount left over is (endt + (to - |
492 from)) - to, which is endt - from. */ | |
314 | 493 bcopy (from, to, endt - from); |
494 } | |
495 } | |
496 } | |
497 | |
25012 | 498 |
499 | |
500 /*********************************************************************** | |
501 Glyph Matrices | |
502 ***********************************************************************/ | |
503 | |
504 /* Allocate and return a glyph_matrix structure. POOL is the glyph | |
505 pool from which memory for the matrix should be allocated, or null | |
506 for window-based redisplay where no glyph pools are used. The | |
507 member `pool' of the glyph matrix structure returned is set to | |
508 POOL, the structure is otherwise zeroed. */ | |
509 | |
510 struct glyph_matrix * | |
511 new_glyph_matrix (pool) | |
512 struct glyph_pool *pool; | |
513 { | |
514 struct glyph_matrix *result; | |
515 | |
516 /* Allocate and clear. */ | |
517 result = (struct glyph_matrix *) xmalloc (sizeof *result); | |
518 bzero (result, sizeof *result); | |
519 | |
520 /* Increment number of allocated matrices. This count is used | |
521 to detect memory leaks. */ | |
522 ++glyph_matrix_count; | |
523 | |
524 /* Set pool and return. */ | |
525 result->pool = pool; | |
526 return result; | |
527 } | |
528 | |
529 | |
530 /* Free glyph matrix MATRIX. Passing in a null MATRIX is allowed. | |
531 | |
532 The global counter glyph_matrix_count is decremented when a matrix | |
533 is freed. If the count gets negative, more structures were freed | |
534 than allocated, i.e. one matrix was freed more than once or a bogus | |
535 pointer was passed to this function. | |
536 | |
537 If MATRIX->pool is null, this means that the matrix manages its own | |
538 glyph memory---this is done for matrices on X frames. Freeing the | |
539 matrix also frees the glyph memory in this case. */ | |
540 | |
541 static void | |
542 free_glyph_matrix (matrix) | |
543 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
544 { | |
545 if (matrix) | |
546 { | |
547 int i; | |
548 | |
549 /* Detect the case that more matrices are freed than were | |
550 allocated. */ | |
551 if (--glyph_matrix_count < 0) | |
552 abort (); | |
553 | |
554 /* Free glyph memory if MATRIX owns it. */ | |
555 if (matrix->pool == NULL) | |
556 for (i = 0; i < matrix->rows_allocated; ++i) | |
557 xfree (matrix->rows[i].glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]); | |
558 | |
559 /* Free row structures and the matrix itself. */ | |
560 xfree (matrix->rows); | |
561 xfree (matrix); | |
562 } | |
563 } | |
564 | |
565 | |
566 /* Return the number of glyphs to reserve for a marginal area of | |
567 window W. TOTAL_GLYPHS is the number of glyphs in a complete | |
568 display line of window W. MARGIN gives the width of the marginal | |
569 area in canonical character units. MARGIN should be an integer | |
570 or a float. */ | |
571 | |
572 static int | |
573 margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, total_glyphs, margin) | |
574 struct window *w; | |
575 int total_glyphs; | |
576 Lisp_Object margin; | |
577 { | |
578 int n; | |
579 | |
580 if (NUMBERP (margin)) | |
581 { | |
582 int width = XFASTINT (w->width); | |
583 double d = max (0, XFLOATINT (margin)); | |
584 d = min (width / 2 - 1, d); | |
585 n = (int) ((double) total_glyphs / width * d); | |
586 } | |
587 else | |
588 n = 0; | |
589 | |
590 return n; | |
591 } | |
592 | |
593 | |
594 /* Adjust glyph matrix MATRIX on window W or on a frame to changed | |
595 window sizes. | |
596 | |
597 W is null if the function is called for a frame glyph matrix. | |
598 Otherwise it is the window MATRIX is a member of. X and Y are the | |
599 indices of the first column and row of MATRIX within the frame | |
600 matrix, if such a matrix exists. They are zero for purely | |
601 window-based redisplay. DIM is the needed size of the matrix. | |
602 | |
603 In window-based redisplay, where no frame matrices exist, glyph | |
604 matrices manage their own glyph storage. Otherwise, they allocate | |
605 storage from a common frame glyph pool which can be found in | |
606 MATRIX->pool. | |
607 | |
608 The reason for this memory management strategy is to avoid complete | |
609 frame redraws if possible. When we allocate from a common pool, a | |
610 change of the location or size of a sub-matrix within the pool | |
611 requires a complete redisplay of the frame because we cannot easily | |
612 make sure that the current matrices of all windows still agree with | |
613 what is displayed on the screen. While this is usually fast, it | |
614 leads to screen flickering. */ | |
615 | |
616 static void | |
617 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, matrix, x, y, dim) | |
618 struct window *w; | |
619 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
620 int x, y; | |
621 struct dim dim; | |
622 { | |
623 int i; | |
624 int new_rows; | |
625 int marginal_areas_changed_p = 0; | |
25546 | 626 int header_line_changed_p = 0; |
627 int header_line_p = 0; | |
25012 | 628 int left = -1, right = -1; |
34203
e55480843a8e
(scrolling_window): Fix code inserting runs in list of all runs.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33763
diff
changeset
|
629 int window_x, window_y, window_width = -1, window_height; |
25012 | 630 |
631 /* See if W had a top line that has disappeared now, or vice versa. */ | |
632 if (w) | |
633 { | |
25546 | 634 header_line_p = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w); |
635 header_line_changed_p = header_line_p != matrix->header_line_p; | |
25012 | 636 } |
25546 | 637 matrix->header_line_p = header_line_p; |
25012 | 638 |
639 /* Do nothing if MATRIX' size, position, vscroll, and marginal areas | |
640 haven't changed. This optimization is important because preserving | |
641 the matrix means preventing redisplay. */ | |
642 if (matrix->pool == NULL) | |
643 { | |
644 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height); | |
645 left = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, w->left_margin_width); | |
646 right = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, w->right_margin_width); | |
647 xassert (left >= 0 && right >= 0); | |
648 marginal_areas_changed_p = (left != matrix->left_margin_glyphs | |
649 || right != matrix->right_margin_glyphs); | |
650 | |
651 if (!marginal_areas_changed_p | |
652 && !fonts_changed_p | |
25546 | 653 && !header_line_changed_p |
34279
7ab25b4a077c
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Don't reuse a window's current
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34203
diff
changeset
|
654 && matrix->window_left_x == XFASTINT (w->left) |
25012 | 655 && matrix->window_top_y == XFASTINT (w->top) |
656 && matrix->window_height == window_height | |
657 && matrix->window_vscroll == w->vscroll | |
658 && matrix->window_width == window_width) | |
659 return; | |
660 } | |
661 | |
662 /* Enlarge MATRIX->rows if necessary. New rows are cleared. */ | |
663 if (matrix->rows_allocated < dim.height) | |
664 { | |
665 int size = dim.height * sizeof (struct glyph_row); | |
666 new_rows = dim.height - matrix->rows_allocated; | |
667 matrix->rows = (struct glyph_row *) xrealloc (matrix->rows, size); | |
668 bzero (matrix->rows + matrix->rows_allocated, | |
669 new_rows * sizeof *matrix->rows); | |
670 matrix->rows_allocated = dim.height; | |
671 } | |
672 else | |
673 new_rows = 0; | |
674 | |
675 /* If POOL is not null, MATRIX is a frame matrix or a window matrix | |
676 on a frame not using window-based redisplay. Set up pointers for | |
677 each row into the glyph pool. */ | |
678 if (matrix->pool) | |
679 { | |
680 xassert (matrix->pool->glyphs); | |
681 | |
682 if (w) | |
683 { | |
684 left = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, | |
685 w->left_margin_width); | |
686 right = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, | |
687 w->right_margin_width); | |
688 } | |
689 else | |
690 left = right = 0; | |
691 | |
692 for (i = 0; i < dim.height; ++i) | |
693 { | |
694 struct glyph_row *row = &matrix->rows[i]; | |
695 | |
696 row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
697 = (matrix->pool->glyphs | |
698 + (y + i) * matrix->pool->ncolumns | |
699 + x); | |
700 | |
701 if (w == NULL | |
702 || row == matrix->rows + dim.height - 1 | |
25546 | 703 || (row == matrix->rows && matrix->header_line_p)) |
25012 | 704 { |
705 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
706 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
707 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
708 = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + dim.width; | |
709 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] | |
710 = row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
711 } | |
712 else | |
713 { | |
714 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
715 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + left; | |
716 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
717 = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + dim.width - left - right; | |
718 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] | |
719 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + dim.width; | |
720 } | |
721 } | |
722 | |
723 matrix->left_margin_glyphs = left; | |
724 matrix->right_margin_glyphs = right; | |
725 } | |
726 else | |
727 { | |
728 /* If MATRIX->pool is null, MATRIX is responsible for managing | |
729 its own memory. Allocate glyph memory from the heap. */ | |
730 if (dim.width > matrix->matrix_w | |
731 || new_rows | |
25546 | 732 || header_line_changed_p |
25012 | 733 || marginal_areas_changed_p) |
734 { | |
735 struct glyph_row *row = matrix->rows; | |
736 struct glyph_row *end = row + matrix->rows_allocated; | |
737 | |
738 while (row < end) | |
739 { | |
740 row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
741 = (struct glyph *) xrealloc (row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA], | |
742 (dim.width | |
743 * sizeof (struct glyph))); | |
744 | |
745 /* The mode line never has marginal areas. */ | |
746 if (row == matrix->rows + dim.height - 1 | |
25546 | 747 || (row == matrix->rows && matrix->header_line_p)) |
25012 | 748 { |
749 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
750 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
751 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
752 = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + dim.width; | |
753 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] | |
754 = row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
755 } | |
756 else | |
757 { | |
758 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
759 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + left; | |
760 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
761 = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + dim.width - left - right; | |
762 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] | |
763 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + dim.width; | |
764 } | |
765 ++row; | |
766 } | |
767 } | |
768 | |
769 xassert (left >= 0 && right >= 0); | |
770 matrix->left_margin_glyphs = left; | |
771 matrix->right_margin_glyphs = right; | |
772 } | |
773 | |
774 /* Number of rows to be used by MATRIX. */ | |
775 matrix->nrows = dim.height; | |
31932
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
776 xassert (matrix->nrows >= 0); |
25012 | 777 |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
778 if (w) |
25012 | 779 { |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
780 if (matrix == w->current_matrix) |
25012 | 781 { |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
782 /* Mark rows in a current matrix of a window as not having |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
783 valid contents. It's important to not do this for |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
784 desired matrices. When Emacs starts, it may already be |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
785 building desired matrices when this function runs. */ |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
786 if (window_width < 0) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
787 window_width = window_box_width (w, -1); |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
788 |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
789 /* Optimize the case that only the height has changed (C-x 2, |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
790 upper window). Invalidate all rows that are no longer part |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
791 of the window. */ |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
792 if (!marginal_areas_changed_p |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
793 && matrix->window_left_x == XFASTINT (w->left) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
794 && matrix->window_top_y == XFASTINT (w->top) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
795 && matrix->window_width == window_box_width (w, -1)) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
796 { |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
797 i = 0; |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
798 while (matrix->rows[i].enabled_p |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
799 && (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (matrix->rows + i) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
800 < matrix->window_height)) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
801 ++i; |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
802 |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
803 /* Window end is invalid, if inside of the rows that |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
804 are invalidated. */ |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
805 if (INTEGERP (w->window_end_vpos) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
806 && XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) >= i) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
807 w->window_end_valid = Qnil; |
25012 | 808 |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
809 while (i < matrix->nrows) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
810 matrix->rows[i++].enabled_p = 0; |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
811 } |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
812 else |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
813 { |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
814 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
815 matrix->rows[i].enabled_p = 0; |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
816 } |
25012 | 817 } |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
818 else if (matrix == w->desired_matrix) |
25012 | 819 { |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
820 /* Rows in desired matrices always have to be cleared; |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
821 redisplay expects this is the case when it runs, so it |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
822 had better be the case when we adjust matrices between |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
823 redisplays. */ |
25012 | 824 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i) |
825 matrix->rows[i].enabled_p = 0; | |
826 } | |
827 } | |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
828 |
25012 | 829 |
830 /* Remember last values to be able to optimize frame redraws. */ | |
831 matrix->matrix_x = x; | |
832 matrix->matrix_y = y; | |
833 matrix->matrix_w = dim.width; | |
834 matrix->matrix_h = dim.height; | |
835 | |
836 /* Record the top y location and height of W at the time the matrix | |
837 was last adjusted. This is used to optimize redisplay above. */ | |
838 if (w) | |
839 { | |
34279
7ab25b4a077c
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Don't reuse a window's current
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34203
diff
changeset
|
840 matrix->window_left_x = XFASTINT (w->left); |
25012 | 841 matrix->window_top_y = XFASTINT (w->top); |
842 matrix->window_height = window_height; | |
843 matrix->window_width = window_width; | |
844 matrix->window_vscroll = w->vscroll; | |
845 } | |
846 } | |
847 | |
848 | |
849 /* Reverse the contents of rows in MATRIX between START and END. The | |
850 contents of the row at END - 1 end up at START, END - 2 at START + | |
851 1 etc. This is part of the implementation of rotate_matrix (see | |
852 below). */ | |
314 | 853 |
854 static void | |
25012 | 855 reverse_rows (matrix, start, end) |
856 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
857 int start, end; | |
314 | 858 { |
25012 | 859 int i, j; |
860 | |
861 for (i = start, j = end - 1; i < j; ++i, --j) | |
862 { | |
863 /* Non-ISO HP/UX compiler doesn't like auto struct | |
864 initialization. */ | |
865 struct glyph_row temp; | |
866 temp = matrix->rows[i]; | |
867 matrix->rows[i] = matrix->rows[j]; | |
868 matrix->rows[j] = temp; | |
869 } | |
314 | 870 } |
871 | |
25012 | 872 |
873 /* Rotate the contents of rows in MATRIX in the range FIRST .. LAST - | |
874 1 by BY positions. BY < 0 means rotate left, i.e. towards lower | |
875 indices. (Note: this does not copy glyphs, only glyph pointers in | |
876 row structures are moved around). | |
877 | |
878 The algorithm used for rotating the vector was, I believe, first | |
879 described by Kernighan. See the vector R as consisting of two | |
880 sub-vectors AB, where A has length BY for BY >= 0. The result | |
881 after rotating is then BA. Reverse both sub-vectors to get ArBr | |
882 and reverse the result to get (ArBr)r which is BA. Similar for | |
883 rotating right. */ | |
884 | |
885 void | |
886 rotate_matrix (matrix, first, last, by) | |
887 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
888 int first, last, by; | |
314 | 889 { |
25012 | 890 if (by < 0) |
891 { | |
892 /* Up (rotate left, i.e. towards lower indices). */ | |
893 by = -by; | |
894 reverse_rows (matrix, first, first + by); | |
895 reverse_rows (matrix, first + by, last); | |
896 reverse_rows (matrix, first, last); | |
897 } | |
898 else if (by > 0) | |
314 | 899 { |
25012 | 900 /* Down (rotate right, i.e. towards higher indices). */ |
901 reverse_rows (matrix, last - by, last); | |
902 reverse_rows (matrix, first, last - by); | |
903 reverse_rows (matrix, first, last); | |
314 | 904 } |
25012 | 905 } |
906 | |
907 | |
908 /* Increment buffer positions in glyph rows of MATRIX. Do it for rows | |
909 with indices START <= index < END. Increment positions by DELTA/ | |
910 DELTA_BYTES. */ | |
911 | |
912 void | |
28708
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
913 increment_matrix_positions (matrix, start, end, delta, delta_bytes) |
25012 | 914 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; |
915 int start, end, delta, delta_bytes; | |
916 { | |
917 /* Check that START and END are reasonable values. */ | |
918 xassert (start >= 0 && start <= matrix->nrows); | |
919 xassert (end >= 0 && end <= matrix->nrows); | |
920 xassert (start <= end); | |
921 | |
922 for (; start < end; ++start) | |
28708
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
923 increment_row_positions (matrix->rows + start, delta, delta_bytes); |
25012 | 924 } |
925 | |
926 | |
927 /* Enable a range of rows in glyph matrix MATRIX. START and END are | |
928 the row indices of the first and last + 1 row to enable. If | |
929 ENABLED_P is non-zero, enabled_p flags in rows will be set to 1. */ | |
930 | |
931 void | |
932 enable_glyph_matrix_rows (matrix, start, end, enabled_p) | |
933 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
934 int start, end; | |
935 int enabled_p; | |
936 { | |
31932
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
937 xassert (start <= end); |
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
938 xassert (start >= 0 && start < matrix->nrows); |
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
939 xassert (end >= 0 && end <= matrix->nrows); |
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
940 |
25012 | 941 for (; start < end; ++start) |
942 matrix->rows[start].enabled_p = enabled_p != 0; | |
943 } | |
944 | |
945 | |
946 /* Clear MATRIX. | |
947 | |
948 This empties all rows in MATRIX by setting the enabled_p flag for | |
949 all rows of the matrix to zero. The function prepare_desired_row | |
950 will eventually really clear a row when it sees one with a zero | |
951 enabled_p flag. | |
952 | |
953 Resets update hints to defaults value. The only update hint | |
954 currently present is the flag MATRIX->no_scrolling_p. */ | |
955 | |
956 void | |
957 clear_glyph_matrix (matrix) | |
958 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
959 { | |
960 if (matrix) | |
314 | 961 { |
25012 | 962 enable_glyph_matrix_rows (matrix, 0, matrix->nrows, 0); |
963 matrix->no_scrolling_p = 0; | |
314 | 964 } |
965 } | |
25012 | 966 |
967 | |
968 /* Shift part of the glyph matrix MATRIX of window W up or down. | |
969 Increment y-positions in glyph rows between START and END by DY, | |
970 and recompute their visible height. */ | |
971 | |
972 void | |
973 shift_glyph_matrix (w, matrix, start, end, dy) | |
974 struct window *w; | |
975 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
976 int start, end, dy; | |
977 { | |
978 int min_y, max_y; | |
979 | |
980 xassert (start <= end); | |
981 xassert (start >= 0 && start < matrix->nrows); | |
982 xassert (end >= 0 && end <= matrix->nrows); | |
983 | |
25546 | 984 min_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w); |
25012 | 985 max_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (w); |
986 | |
987 for (; start < end; ++start) | |
988 { | |
989 struct glyph_row *row = &matrix->rows[start]; | |
990 | |
991 row->y += dy; | |
992 | |
993 if (row->y < min_y) | |
994 row->visible_height = row->height - (min_y - row->y); | |
995 else if (row->y + row->height > max_y) | |
996 row->visible_height = row->height - (row->y + row->height - max_y); | |
997 else | |
998 row->visible_height = row->height; | |
999 } | |
1000 } | |
1001 | |
1002 | |
1003 /* Mark all rows in current matrices of frame F as invalid. Marking | |
1004 invalid is done by setting enabled_p to zero for all rows in a | |
1005 current matrix. */ | |
1006 | |
1007 void | |
1008 clear_current_matrices (f) | |
1009 register struct frame *f; | |
1010 { | |
1011 /* Clear frame current matrix, if we have one. */ | |
1012 if (f->current_matrix) | |
1013 clear_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix); | |
1014 | |
1015 /* Clear the matrix of the menu bar window, if such a window exists. | |
1016 The menu bar window is currently used to display menus on X when | |
1017 no toolkit support is compiled in. */ | |
1018 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
1019 clear_glyph_matrix (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window)->current_matrix); | |
1020 | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
1021 /* Clear the matrix of the tool-bar window, if any. */ |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
1022 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
1023 clear_glyph_matrix (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->current_matrix); |
25012 | 1024 |
1025 /* Clear current window matrices. */ | |
1026 xassert (WINDOWP (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))); | |
1027 clear_window_matrices (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)), 0); | |
1028 } | |
1029 | |
1030 | |
1031 /* Clear out all display lines of F for a coming redisplay. */ | |
314 | 1032 |
21514 | 1033 void |
25012 | 1034 clear_desired_matrices (f) |
1035 register struct frame *f; | |
314 | 1036 { |
25012 | 1037 if (f->desired_matrix) |
1038 clear_glyph_matrix (f->desired_matrix); | |
1039 | |
1040 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
1041 clear_glyph_matrix (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window)->desired_matrix); | |
1042 | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
1043 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
1044 clear_glyph_matrix (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->desired_matrix); |
25012 | 1045 |
1046 /* Do it for window matrices. */ | |
1047 xassert (WINDOWP (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))); | |
1048 clear_window_matrices (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)), 1); | |
1049 } | |
1050 | |
1051 | |
1052 /* Clear matrices in window tree rooted in W. If DESIRED_P is | |
1053 non-zero clear desired matrices, otherwise clear current matrices. */ | |
1054 | |
1055 static void | |
1056 clear_window_matrices (w, desired_p) | |
1057 struct window *w; | |
1058 int desired_p; | |
1059 { | |
1060 while (w) | |
314 | 1061 { |
25012 | 1062 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
1063 { | |
1064 xassert (WINDOWP (w->hchild)); | |
1065 clear_window_matrices (XWINDOW (w->hchild), desired_p); | |
1066 } | |
1067 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
314 | 1068 { |
25012 | 1069 xassert (WINDOWP (w->vchild)); |
1070 clear_window_matrices (XWINDOW (w->vchild), desired_p); | |
1071 } | |
1072 else | |
1073 { | |
1074 if (desired_p) | |
1075 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix); | |
1076 else | |
314 | 1077 { |
25012 | 1078 clear_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix); |
1079 w->window_end_valid = Qnil; | |
314 | 1080 } |
25012 | 1081 } |
1082 | |
1083 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
1084 } | |
1085 } | |
1086 | |
1087 | |
1088 | |
1089 /*********************************************************************** | |
1090 Glyph Rows | |
1091 | |
1092 See dispextern.h for an overall explanation of glyph rows. | |
1093 ***********************************************************************/ | |
1094 | |
1095 /* Clear glyph row ROW. Do it in a way that makes it robust against | |
1096 changes in the glyph_row structure, i.e. addition or removal of | |
1097 structure members. */ | |
1098 | |
33527
c4c7abc48752
(null_row): New gloval static variable.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
33101
diff
changeset
|
1099 static struct glyph_row null_row; |
c4c7abc48752
(null_row): New gloval static variable.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
33101
diff
changeset
|
1100 |
25012 | 1101 void |
1102 clear_glyph_row (row) | |
1103 struct glyph_row *row; | |
1104 { | |
1105 struct glyph *p[1 + LAST_AREA]; | |
1106 | |
1107 /* Save pointers. */ | |
1108 p[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
1109 p[TEXT_AREA] = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
1110 p[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
1111 p[LAST_AREA] = row->glyphs[LAST_AREA]; | |
1112 | |
1113 /* Clear. */ | |
1114 *row = null_row; | |
1115 | |
1116 /* Restore pointers. */ | |
1117 row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = p[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
1118 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = p[TEXT_AREA]; | |
1119 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = p[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
1120 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] = p[LAST_AREA]; | |
30041
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1121 |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1122 #if 0 /* At some point, some bit-fields of struct glyph were not set, |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1123 which made glyphs unequal when compared with GLYPH_EQUAL_P. |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1124 Redisplay outputs such glyphs, and flickering effects were |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1125 the result. This also depended on the contents of memory |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1126 returned by xmalloc. If flickering happens again, activate |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1127 the code below If the flickering is gone with that, chances |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1128 are that the flickering has the same reason as here. */ |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1129 bzero (p[0], (char *) p[LAST_AREA] - (char *) p[0]); |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1130 #endif |
25012 | 1131 } |
1132 | |
1133 | |
1134 /* Make ROW an empty, enabled row of canonical character height, | |
1135 in window W starting at y-position Y. */ | |
1136 | |
1137 void | |
1138 blank_row (w, row, y) | |
1139 struct window *w; | |
1140 struct glyph_row *row; | |
1141 int y; | |
1142 { | |
1143 int min_y, max_y; | |
1144 | |
25546 | 1145 min_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w); |
25012 | 1146 max_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (w); |
1147 | |
1148 clear_glyph_row (row); | |
1149 row->y = y; | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1150 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1151 row->height = row->phys_height = CANON_Y_UNIT (XFRAME (w->frame)); |
25012 | 1152 |
1153 if (row->y < min_y) | |
1154 row->visible_height = row->height - (min_y - row->y); | |
1155 else if (row->y + row->height > max_y) | |
1156 row->visible_height = row->height - (row->y + row->height - max_y); | |
1157 else | |
1158 row->visible_height = row->height; | |
1159 | |
1160 row->enabled_p = 1; | |
1161 } | |
1162 | |
1163 | |
1164 /* Increment buffer positions in glyph row ROW. DELTA and DELTA_BYTES | |
1165 are the amounts by which to change positions. Note that the first | |
1166 glyph of the text area of a row can have a buffer position even if | |
1167 the used count of the text area is zero. Such rows display line | |
1168 ends. */ | |
1169 | |
1170 void | |
28708
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
1171 increment_row_positions (row, delta, delta_bytes) |
25012 | 1172 struct glyph_row *row; |
1173 int delta, delta_bytes; | |
1174 { | |
1175 int area, i; | |
1176 | |
1177 /* Increment start and end positions. */ | |
1178 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) += delta; | |
1179 MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) += delta_bytes; | |
1180 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) += delta; | |
1181 MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) += delta_bytes; | |
1182 | |
1183 /* Increment positions in glyphs. */ | |
1184 for (area = 0; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) | |
1185 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area]; ++i) | |
1186 if (BUFFERP (row->glyphs[area][i].object) | |
1187 && row->glyphs[area][i].charpos > 0) | |
1188 row->glyphs[area][i].charpos += delta; | |
1189 | |
1190 /* Capture the case of rows displaying a line end. */ | |
1191 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0 | |
1192 && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)) | |
1193 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos += delta; | |
1194 } | |
1195 | |
1196 | |
29336
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1197 #if 0 |
25012 | 1198 /* Swap glyphs between two glyph rows A and B. This exchanges glyph |
1199 contents, i.e. glyph structure contents are exchanged between A and | |
1200 B without changing glyph pointers in A and B. */ | |
1201 | |
1202 static void | |
1203 swap_glyphs_in_rows (a, b) | |
1204 struct glyph_row *a, *b; | |
1205 { | |
1206 int area; | |
1207 | |
1208 for (area = 0; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) | |
1209 { | |
1210 /* Number of glyphs to swap. */ | |
1211 int max_used = max (a->used[area], b->used[area]); | |
1212 | |
1213 /* Start of glyphs in area of row A. */ | |
1214 struct glyph *glyph_a = a->glyphs[area]; | |
1215 | |
1216 /* End + 1 of glyphs in area of row A. */ | |
1217 struct glyph *glyph_a_end = a->glyphs[max_used]; | |
1218 | |
1219 /* Start of glyphs in area of row B. */ | |
1220 struct glyph *glyph_b = b->glyphs[area]; | |
1221 | |
1222 while (glyph_a < glyph_a_end) | |
1223 { | |
1224 /* Non-ISO HP/UX compiler doesn't like auto struct | |
1225 initialization. */ | |
1226 struct glyph temp; | |
1227 temp = *glyph_a; | |
1228 *glyph_a = *glyph_b; | |
1229 *glyph_b = temp; | |
1230 ++glyph_a; | |
1231 ++glyph_b; | |
314 | 1232 } |
1233 } | |
1234 } | |
25012 | 1235 |
29336
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1236 #endif /* 0 */ |
25012 | 1237 |
1238 /* Exchange pointers to glyph memory between glyph rows A and B. */ | |
1239 | |
1240 static INLINE void | |
1241 swap_glyph_pointers (a, b) | |
1242 struct glyph_row *a, *b; | |
1243 { | |
1244 int i; | |
1245 for (i = 0; i < LAST_AREA + 1; ++i) | |
1246 { | |
1247 struct glyph *temp = a->glyphs[i]; | |
1248 a->glyphs[i] = b->glyphs[i]; | |
1249 b->glyphs[i] = temp; | |
1250 } | |
1251 } | |
1252 | |
1253 | |
1254 /* Copy glyph row structure FROM to glyph row structure TO, except | |
1255 that glyph pointers in the structures are left unchanged. */ | |
1256 | |
1257 INLINE void | |
1258 copy_row_except_pointers (to, from) | |
1259 struct glyph_row *to, *from; | |
1260 { | |
1261 struct glyph *pointers[1 + LAST_AREA]; | |
1262 | |
1263 /* Save glyph pointers of TO. */ | |
1264 bcopy (to->glyphs, pointers, sizeof to->glyphs); | |
1265 | |
1266 /* Do a structure assignment. */ | |
1267 *to = *from; | |
1268 | |
1269 /* Restore original pointers of TO. */ | |
1270 bcopy (pointers, to->glyphs, sizeof to->glyphs); | |
1271 } | |
1272 | |
1273 | |
1274 /* Copy contents of glyph row FROM to glyph row TO. Glyph pointers in | |
1275 TO and FROM are left unchanged. Glyph contents are copied from the | |
1276 glyph memory of FROM to the glyph memory of TO. Increment buffer | |
1277 positions in row TO by DELTA/ DELTA_BYTES. */ | |
1278 | |
1279 void | |
1280 copy_glyph_row_contents (to, from, delta, delta_bytes) | |
1281 struct glyph_row *to, *from; | |
1282 int delta, delta_bytes; | |
1283 { | |
1284 int area; | |
1285 | |
1286 /* This is like a structure assignment TO = FROM, except that | |
1287 glyph pointers in the rows are left unchanged. */ | |
1288 copy_row_except_pointers (to, from); | |
1289 | |
1290 /* Copy glyphs from FROM to TO. */ | |
1291 for (area = 0; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) | |
1292 if (from->used[area]) | |
1293 bcopy (from->glyphs[area], to->glyphs[area], | |
1294 from->used[area] * sizeof (struct glyph)); | |
1295 | |
1296 /* Increment buffer positions in TO by DELTA. */ | |
28708
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
1297 increment_row_positions (to, delta, delta_bytes); |
25012 | 1298 } |
1299 | |
1300 | |
1301 /* Assign glyph row FROM to glyph row TO. This works like a structure | |
1302 assignment TO = FROM, except that glyph pointers are not copied but | |
1303 exchanged between TO and FROM. Pointers must be exchanged to avoid | |
1304 a memory leak. */ | |
1305 | |
1306 static INLINE void | |
1307 assign_row (to, from) | |
1308 struct glyph_row *to, *from; | |
1309 { | |
1310 swap_glyph_pointers (to, from); | |
1311 copy_row_except_pointers (to, from); | |
1312 } | |
1313 | |
1314 | |
1315 /* Test whether the glyph memory of the glyph row WINDOW_ROW, which is | |
1316 a row in a window matrix, is a slice of the glyph memory of the | |
1317 glyph row FRAME_ROW which is a row in a frame glyph matrix. Value | |
1318 is non-zero if the glyph memory of WINDOW_ROW is part of the glyph | |
1319 memory of FRAME_ROW. */ | |
1320 | |
34893
779bd3fa820e
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34866
diff
changeset
|
1321 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
30323
4cd1b8fe118c
(direct_output_for_insert): Remove confusing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30307
diff
changeset
|
1322 |
25012 | 1323 static int |
1324 glyph_row_slice_p (window_row, frame_row) | |
1325 struct glyph_row *window_row, *frame_row; | |
1326 { | |
1327 struct glyph *window_glyph_start = window_row->glyphs[0]; | |
1328 struct glyph *frame_glyph_start = frame_row->glyphs[0]; | |
1329 struct glyph *frame_glyph_end = frame_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA]; | |
1330 | |
1331 return (frame_glyph_start <= window_glyph_start | |
1332 && window_glyph_start < frame_glyph_end); | |
1333 } | |
1334 | |
30323
4cd1b8fe118c
(direct_output_for_insert): Remove confusing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30307
diff
changeset
|
1335 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */ |
25012 | 1336 |
29336
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1337 #if 0 |
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1338 |
25012 | 1339 /* Find the row in the window glyph matrix WINDOW_MATRIX being a slice |
1340 of ROW in the frame matrix FRAME_MATRIX. Value is null if no row | |
1341 in WINDOW_MATRIX is found satisfying the condition. */ | |
1342 | |
1343 static struct glyph_row * | |
1344 find_glyph_row_slice (window_matrix, frame_matrix, row) | |
1345 struct glyph_matrix *window_matrix, *frame_matrix; | |
1346 int row; | |
1347 { | |
1348 int i; | |
1349 | |
1350 xassert (row >= 0 && row < frame_matrix->nrows); | |
1351 | |
1352 for (i = 0; i < window_matrix->nrows; ++i) | |
1353 if (glyph_row_slice_p (window_matrix->rows + i, | |
1354 frame_matrix->rows + row)) | |
1355 break; | |
1356 | |
1357 return i < window_matrix->nrows ? window_matrix->rows + i : 0; | |
1358 } | |
1359 | |
29336
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1360 #endif /* 0 */ |
25012 | 1361 |
1362 /* Prepare ROW for display. Desired rows are cleared lazily, | |
1363 i.e. they are only marked as to be cleared by setting their | |
1364 enabled_p flag to zero. When a row is to be displayed, a prior | |
1365 call to this function really clears it. */ | |
1366 | |
1367 void | |
1368 prepare_desired_row (row) | |
1369 struct glyph_row *row; | |
1370 { | |
1371 if (!row->enabled_p) | |
1372 { | |
1373 clear_glyph_row (row); | |
1374 row->enabled_p = 1; | |
1375 } | |
1376 } | |
1377 | |
1378 | |
1379 /* Return a hash code for glyph row ROW. */ | |
1380 | |
1381 int | |
1382 line_hash_code (row) | |
1383 struct glyph_row *row; | |
1384 { | |
1385 int hash = 0; | |
1386 | |
1387 if (row->enabled_p) | |
1388 { | |
1389 if (row->inverse_p) | |
1390 { | |
1391 /* Give all highlighted lines the same hash code | |
1392 so as to encourage scrolling to leave them in place. */ | |
1393 hash = -1; | |
1394 } | |
1395 else | |
1396 { | |
1397 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
1398 struct glyph *end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
1399 | |
1400 while (glyph < end) | |
1401 { | |
26998
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
1402 int c = glyph->u.ch; |
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
1403 int face_id = glyph->face_id; |
25012 | 1404 if (must_write_spaces) |
26998
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
1405 c -= SPACEGLYPH; |
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
1406 hash = (((hash << 4) + (hash >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff) + c; |
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
1407 hash = (((hash << 4) + (hash >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff) + face_id; |
25012 | 1408 ++glyph; |
1409 } | |
1410 | |
1411 if (hash == 0) | |
1412 hash = 1; | |
1413 } | |
1414 } | |
1415 | |
1416 return hash; | |
1417 } | |
1418 | |
1419 | |
1420 /* Return the cost of drawing line VPOS In MATRIX. The cost equals | |
1421 the number of characters in the line. If must_write_spaces is | |
1422 zero, leading and trailing spaces are ignored. */ | |
1423 | |
1424 static unsigned int | |
1425 line_draw_cost (matrix, vpos) | |
1426 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
1427 int vpos; | |
1428 { | |
1429 struct glyph_row *row = matrix->rows + vpos; | |
1430 struct glyph *beg = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
1431 struct glyph *end = beg + row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
1432 int len; | |
1433 Lisp_Object *glyph_table_base = GLYPH_TABLE_BASE; | |
1434 int glyph_table_len = GLYPH_TABLE_LENGTH; | |
1435 | |
1436 /* Ignore trailing and leading spaces if we can. */ | |
1437 if (!must_write_spaces) | |
1438 { | |
1439 /* Skip from the end over trailing spaces. */ | |
34203
e55480843a8e
(scrolling_window): Fix code inserting runs in list of all runs.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33763
diff
changeset
|
1440 while (end > beg && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (*(end - 1))) |
25012 | 1441 --end; |
1442 | |
1443 /* All blank line. */ | |
1444 if (end == beg) | |
1445 return 0; | |
1446 | |
1447 /* Skip over leading spaces. */ | |
1448 while (CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (*beg)) | |
1449 ++beg; | |
1450 } | |
1451 | |
1452 /* If we don't have a glyph-table, each glyph is one character, | |
1453 so return the number of glyphs. */ | |
1454 if (glyph_table_base == 0) | |
1455 len = end - beg; | |
1456 else | |
1457 { | |
1458 /* Otherwise, scan the glyphs and accumulate their total length | |
1459 in LEN. */ | |
1460 len = 0; | |
1461 while (beg < end) | |
1462 { | |
1463 GLYPH g = GLYPH_FROM_CHAR_GLYPH (*beg); | |
1464 | |
26998
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
1465 if (g < 0 |
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
1466 || GLYPH_SIMPLE_P (glyph_table_base, glyph_table_len, g)) |
25012 | 1467 len += 1; |
1468 else | |
1469 len += GLYPH_LENGTH (glyph_table_base, g); | |
1470 | |
1471 ++beg; | |
1472 } | |
1473 } | |
1474 | |
1475 return len; | |
1476 } | |
1477 | |
1478 | |
1479 /* Test two glyph rows A and B for equality. Value is non-zero if A | |
1480 and B have equal contents. W is the window to which the glyphs | |
1481 rows A and B belong. It is needed here to test for partial row | |
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1482 visibility. MOUSE_FACE_P non-zero means compare the mouse_face_p |
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1483 flags of A and B, too. */ |
25012 | 1484 |
1485 static INLINE int | |
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1486 row_equal_p (w, a, b, mouse_face_p) |
25012 | 1487 struct window *w; |
1488 struct glyph_row *a, *b; | |
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1489 int mouse_face_p; |
25012 | 1490 { |
1491 if (a == b) | |
1492 return 1; | |
1493 else if (a->hash != b->hash) | |
1494 return 0; | |
1495 else | |
1496 { | |
1497 struct glyph *a_glyph, *b_glyph, *a_end; | |
1498 int area; | |
1499 | |
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1500 if (mouse_face_p && a->mouse_face_p != b->mouse_face_p) |
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1501 return 0; |
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1502 |
25012 | 1503 /* Compare glyphs. */ |
1504 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) | |
1505 { | |
1506 if (a->used[area] != b->used[area]) | |
1507 return 0; | |
1508 | |
1509 a_glyph = a->glyphs[area]; | |
1510 a_end = a_glyph + a->used[area]; | |
1511 b_glyph = b->glyphs[area]; | |
1512 | |
1513 while (a_glyph < a_end | |
1514 && GLYPH_EQUAL_P (a_glyph, b_glyph)) | |
1515 ++a_glyph, ++b_glyph; | |
1516 | |
1517 if (a_glyph != a_end) | |
1518 return 0; | |
1519 } | |
1520 | |
1521 if (a->truncated_on_left_p != b->truncated_on_left_p | |
1522 || a->inverse_p != b->inverse_p | |
1523 || a->fill_line_p != b->fill_line_p | |
1524 || a->truncated_on_right_p != b->truncated_on_right_p | |
1525 || a->overlay_arrow_p != b->overlay_arrow_p | |
1526 || a->continued_p != b->continued_p | |
1527 || a->indicate_empty_line_p != b->indicate_empty_line_p | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1528 || a->overlapped_p != b->overlapped_p |
25012 | 1529 || (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (a) |
1530 != MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (b)) | |
1531 /* Different partially visible characters on left margin. */ | |
1532 || a->x != b->x | |
1533 /* Different height. */ | |
1534 || a->ascent != b->ascent | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1535 || a->phys_ascent != b->phys_ascent |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1536 || a->phys_height != b->phys_height |
25012 | 1537 || a->visible_height != b->visible_height) |
1538 return 0; | |
1539 } | |
1540 | |
1541 return 1; | |
1542 } | |
1543 | |
1544 | |
314 | 1545 |
25012 | 1546 /*********************************************************************** |
1547 Glyph Pool | |
1548 | |
1549 See dispextern.h for an overall explanation of glyph pools. | |
1550 ***********************************************************************/ | |
1551 | |
1552 /* Allocate a glyph_pool structure. The structure returned is | |
1553 initialized with zeros. The global variable glyph_pool_count is | |
1554 incremented for each pool allocated. */ | |
1555 | |
1556 static struct glyph_pool * | |
1557 new_glyph_pool () | |
1558 { | |
1559 struct glyph_pool *result; | |
1560 | |
1561 /* Allocate a new glyph_pool and clear it. */ | |
1562 result = (struct glyph_pool *) xmalloc (sizeof *result); | |
1563 bzero (result, sizeof *result); | |
1564 | |
1565 /* For memory leak and double deletion checking. */ | |
1566 ++glyph_pool_count; | |
1567 | |
1568 return result; | |
1569 } | |
1570 | |
1571 | |
1572 /* Free a glyph_pool structure POOL. The function may be called with | |
1573 a null POOL pointer. The global variable glyph_pool_count is | |
1574 decremented with every pool structure freed. If this count gets | |
1575 negative, more structures were freed than allocated, i.e. one | |
1576 structure must have been freed more than once or a bogus pointer | |
1577 was passed to free_glyph_pool. */ | |
1578 | |
1579 static void | |
1580 free_glyph_pool (pool) | |
1581 struct glyph_pool *pool; | |
1582 { | |
1583 if (pool) | |
1584 { | |
1585 /* More freed than allocated? */ | |
1586 --glyph_pool_count; | |
1587 xassert (glyph_pool_count >= 0); | |
1588 | |
1589 xfree (pool->glyphs); | |
1590 xfree (pool); | |
1591 } | |
1592 } | |
1593 | |
1594 | |
1595 /* Enlarge a glyph pool POOL. MATRIX_DIM gives the number of rows and | |
1596 columns we need. This function never shrinks a pool. The only | |
1597 case in which this would make sense, would be when a frame's size | |
1598 is changed from a large value to a smaller one. But, if someone | |
1599 does it once, we can expect that he will do it again. | |
1600 | |
1601 Value is non-zero if the pool changed in a way which makes | |
1602 re-adjusting window glyph matrices necessary. */ | |
1603 | |
1604 static int | |
1605 realloc_glyph_pool (pool, matrix_dim) | |
1606 struct glyph_pool *pool; | |
1607 struct dim matrix_dim; | |
1608 { | |
1609 int needed; | |
1610 int changed_p; | |
1611 | |
1612 changed_p = (pool->glyphs == 0 | |
1613 || matrix_dim.height != pool->nrows | |
1614 || matrix_dim.width != pool->ncolumns); | |
1615 | |
1616 /* Enlarge the glyph pool. */ | |
1617 needed = matrix_dim.width * matrix_dim.height; | |
1618 if (needed > pool->nglyphs) | |
1619 { | |
1620 int size = needed * sizeof (struct glyph); | |
1621 | |
1622 if (pool->glyphs) | |
1623 pool->glyphs = (struct glyph *) xrealloc (pool->glyphs, size); | |
1624 else | |
1625 { | |
1626 pool->glyphs = (struct glyph *) xmalloc (size); | |
1627 bzero (pool->glyphs, size); | |
1628 } | |
1629 | |
1630 pool->nglyphs = needed; | |
1631 } | |
1632 | |
1633 /* Remember the number of rows and columns because (a) we use then | |
1634 to do sanity checks, and (b) the number of columns determines | |
1635 where rows in the frame matrix start---this must be available to | |
1636 determine pointers to rows of window sub-matrices. */ | |
1637 pool->nrows = matrix_dim.height; | |
1638 pool->ncolumns = matrix_dim.width; | |
1639 | |
1640 return changed_p; | |
1641 } | |
1642 | |
1643 | |
1644 | |
1645 /*********************************************************************** | |
1646 Debug Code | |
1647 ***********************************************************************/ | |
1648 | |
1649 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
1650 | |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1651 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1652 /* Flush standard output. This is sometimes useful to call from |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1653 the debugger. */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1654 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1655 void |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1656 flush_stdout () |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1657 { |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1658 fflush (stdout); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1659 } |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1660 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1661 |
25012 | 1662 /* Check that no glyph pointers have been lost in MATRIX. If a |
1663 pointer has been lost, e.g. by using a structure assignment between | |
1664 rows, at least one pointer must occur more than once in the rows of | |
1665 MATRIX. */ | |
1666 | |
1667 void | |
1668 check_matrix_pointer_lossage (matrix) | |
1669 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
1670 { | |
1671 int i, j; | |
1672 | |
1673 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i) | |
1674 for (j = 0; j < matrix->nrows; ++j) | |
1675 xassert (i == j | |
1676 || (matrix->rows[i].glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
1677 != matrix->rows[j].glyphs[TEXT_AREA])); | |
1678 } | |
1679 | |
1680 | |
1681 /* Get a pointer to glyph row ROW in MATRIX, with bounds checks. */ | |
1682 | |
1683 struct glyph_row * | |
1684 matrix_row (matrix, row) | |
1685 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
1686 int row; | |
1687 { | |
1688 xassert (matrix && matrix->rows); | |
1689 xassert (row >= 0 && row < matrix->nrows); | |
1690 | |
1691 /* That's really too slow for normal testing because this function | |
1692 is called almost everywhere. Although---it's still astonishingly | |
1693 fast, so it is valuable to have for debugging purposes. */ | |
314 | 1694 #if 0 |
25012 | 1695 check_matrix_pointer_lossage (matrix); |
1696 #endif | |
1697 | |
1698 return matrix->rows + row; | |
1699 } | |
1700 | |
1701 | |
1702 #if 0 /* This function makes invalid assumptions when text is | |
1703 partially invisible. But it might come handy for debugging | |
1704 nevertheless. */ | |
1705 | |
1706 /* Check invariants that must hold for an up to date current matrix of | |
1707 window W. */ | |
1708 | |
1709 static void | |
1710 check_matrix_invariants (w) | |
314 | 1711 struct window *w; |
1712 { | |
25012 | 1713 struct glyph_matrix *matrix = w->current_matrix; |
1714 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); | |
1715 struct glyph_row *row = matrix->rows; | |
1716 struct glyph_row *last_text_row = NULL; | |
1717 struct buffer *saved = current_buffer; | |
1718 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer); | |
1719 int c; | |
1720 | |
1721 /* This can sometimes happen for a fresh window. */ | |
1722 if (matrix->nrows < 2) | |
1723 return; | |
1724 | |
1725 set_buffer_temp (buffer); | |
1726 | |
1727 /* Note: last row is always reserved for the mode line. */ | |
1728 while (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row) | |
1729 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < yb) | |
1730 { | |
1731 struct glyph_row *next = row + 1; | |
1732 | |
1733 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)) | |
1734 last_text_row = row; | |
1735 | |
1736 /* Check that character and byte positions are in sync. */ | |
1737 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) | |
1738 == CHAR_TO_BYTE (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))); | |
1739 | |
1740 /* CHAR_TO_BYTE aborts when invoked for a position > Z. We can | |
1741 have such a position temporarily in case of a minibuffer | |
1742 displaying something like `[Sole completion]' at its end. */ | |
1743 if (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < BUF_ZV (current_buffer)) | |
1744 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) | |
1745 == CHAR_TO_BYTE (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))); | |
1746 | |
1747 /* Check that end position of `row' is equal to start position | |
1748 of next row. */ | |
1749 if (next->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (next)) | |
1750 { | |
1751 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) | |
1752 == MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (next)); | |
1753 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) | |
1754 == MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (next)); | |
1755 } | |
1756 row = next; | |
1757 } | |
1758 | |
1759 xassert (w->current_matrix->nrows == w->desired_matrix->nrows); | |
1760 xassert (w->desired_matrix->rows != NULL); | |
1761 set_buffer_temp (saved); | |
1762 } | |
1763 | |
1764 #endif /* 0 */ | |
1765 | |
1766 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */ | |
1767 | |
1768 | |
1769 | |
1770 /********************************************************************** | |
1771 Allocating/ Adjusting Glyph Matrices | |
1772 **********************************************************************/ | |
1773 | |
1774 /* Allocate glyph matrices over a window tree for a frame-based | |
1775 redisplay | |
1776 | |
1777 X and Y are column/row within the frame glyph matrix where | |
1778 sub-matrices for the window tree rooted at WINDOW must be | |
1779 allocated. CH_DIM contains the dimensions of the smallest | |
1780 character that could be used during display. DIM_ONLY_P non-zero | |
1781 means that the caller of this function is only interested in the | |
1782 result matrix dimension, and matrix adjustments should not be | |
1783 performed. | |
1784 | |
1785 The function returns the total width/height of the sub-matrices of | |
1786 the window tree. If called on a frame root window, the computation | |
1787 will take the mini-buffer window into account. | |
1788 | |
1789 *WINDOW_CHANGE_FLAGS is set to a bit mask with bits | |
1790 | |
1791 NEW_LEAF_MATRIX set if any window in the tree did not have a | |
1792 glyph matrices yet, and | |
1793 | |
1794 CHANGED_LEAF_MATRIX set if the dimension or location of a matrix of | |
1795 any window in the tree will be changed or have been changed (see | |
1796 DIM_ONLY_P). | |
1797 | |
1798 *WINDOW_CHANGE_FLAGS must be initialized by the caller of this | |
1799 function. | |
1800 | |
1801 Windows are arranged into chains of windows on the same level | |
1802 through the next fields of window structures. Such a level can be | |
1803 either a sequence of horizontally adjacent windows from left to | |
1804 right, or a sequence of vertically adjacent windows from top to | |
1805 bottom. Each window in a horizontal sequence can be either a leaf | |
1806 window or a vertical sequence; a window in a vertical sequence can | |
1807 be either a leaf or a horizontal sequence. All windows in a | |
1808 horizontal sequence have the same height, and all windows in a | |
1809 vertical sequence have the same width. | |
1810 | |
1811 This function uses, for historical reasons, a more general | |
1812 algorithm to determine glyph matrix dimensions that would be | |
1813 necessary. | |
1814 | |
1815 The matrix height of a horizontal sequence is determined by the | |
1816 maximum height of any matrix in the sequence. The matrix width of | |
1817 a horizontal sequence is computed by adding up matrix widths of | |
1818 windows in the sequence. | |
1819 | |
1820 |<------- result width ------->| | |
1821 +---------+----------+---------+ --- | |
1822 | | | | | | |
1823 | | | | | |
1824 +---------+ | | result height | |
1825 | +---------+ | |
1826 | | | | |
1827 +----------+ --- | |
1828 | |
1829 The matrix width of a vertical sequence is the maximum matrix width | |
1830 of any window in the sequence. Its height is computed by adding up | |
1831 matrix heights of windows in the sequence. | |
1832 | |
1833 |<---- result width -->| | |
1834 +---------+ --- | |
1835 | | | | |
1836 | | | | |
1837 +---------+--+ | | |
1838 | | | | |
1839 | | result height | |
1840 | | | |
1841 +------------+---------+ | | |
1842 | | | | |
1843 | | | | |
1844 +------------+---------+ --- */ | |
1845 | |
1846 /* Bit indicating that a new matrix will be allocated or has been | |
1847 allocated. */ | |
1848 | |
1849 #define NEW_LEAF_MATRIX (1 << 0) | |
1850 | |
1851 /* Bit indicating that a matrix will or has changed its location or | |
1852 size. */ | |
1853 | |
1854 #define CHANGED_LEAF_MATRIX (1 << 1) | |
1855 | |
1856 static struct dim | |
1857 allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (window, x, y, ch_dim, | |
1858 dim_only_p, window_change_flags) | |
1859 Lisp_Object window; | |
1860 int x, y; | |
1861 struct dim ch_dim; | |
1862 int dim_only_p; | |
1863 int *window_change_flags; | |
1864 { | |
1865 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))); | |
1866 int x0 = x, y0 = y; | |
1867 int wmax = 0, hmax = 0; | |
1868 struct dim total; | |
1869 struct dim dim; | |
1870 struct window *w; | |
1871 int in_horz_combination_p; | |
1872 | |
1873 /* What combination is WINDOW part of? Compute this once since the | |
1874 result is the same for all windows in the `next' chain. The | |
1875 special case of a root window (parent equal to nil) is treated | |
1876 like a vertical combination because a root window's `next' | |
1877 points to the mini-buffer window, if any, which is arranged | |
1878 vertically below other windows. */ | |
1879 in_horz_combination_p | |
1880 = (!NILP (XWINDOW (window)->parent) | |
1881 && !NILP (XWINDOW (XWINDOW (window)->parent)->hchild)); | |
1882 | |
1883 /* For WINDOW and all windows on the same level. */ | |
1884 do | |
1885 { | |
1886 w = XWINDOW (window); | |
1887 | |
1888 /* Get the dimension of the window sub-matrix for W, depending | |
1889 on whether this a combination or a leaf window. */ | |
1890 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
1891 dim = allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (w->hchild, x, y, ch_dim, | |
1892 dim_only_p, | |
1893 window_change_flags); | |
1894 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
1895 dim = allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (w->vchild, x, y, ch_dim, | |
1896 dim_only_p, | |
1897 window_change_flags); | |
1898 else | |
1899 { | |
1900 /* If not already done, allocate sub-matrix structures. */ | |
1901 if (w->desired_matrix == NULL) | |
1902 { | |
1903 w->desired_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (f->desired_pool); | |
1904 w->current_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (f->current_pool); | |
1905 *window_change_flags |= NEW_LEAF_MATRIX; | |
1906 } | |
1907 | |
1908 /* Width and height MUST be chosen so that there are no | |
1909 holes in the frame matrix. */ | |
28507
b6f06a755c7d
make_number/XINT/XUINT conversions; EQ/== fixes; ==Qnil -> NILP
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
28361
diff
changeset
|
1910 dim.width = XINT (w->width); |
b6f06a755c7d
make_number/XINT/XUINT conversions; EQ/== fixes; ==Qnil -> NILP
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
28361
diff
changeset
|
1911 dim.height = XINT (w->height); |
25012 | 1912 |
1913 /* Will matrix be re-allocated? */ | |
1914 if (x != w->desired_matrix->matrix_x | |
1915 || y != w->desired_matrix->matrix_y | |
1916 || dim.width != w->desired_matrix->matrix_w | |
1917 || dim.height != w->desired_matrix->matrix_h | |
1918 || (margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, | |
1919 w->right_margin_width) | |
1920 != w->desired_matrix->left_margin_glyphs) | |
1921 || (margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, | |
1922 w->left_margin_width) | |
1923 != w->desired_matrix->right_margin_glyphs)) | |
1924 *window_change_flags |= CHANGED_LEAF_MATRIX; | |
1925 | |
1926 /* Actually change matrices, if allowed. Do not consider | |
1927 CHANGED_LEAF_MATRIX computed above here because the pool | |
1928 may have been changed which we don't now here. We trust | |
1929 that we only will be called with DIM_ONLY_P != 0 when | |
1930 necessary. */ | |
1931 if (!dim_only_p) | |
1932 { | |
1933 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, w->desired_matrix, x, y, dim); | |
1934 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, w->current_matrix, x, y, dim); | |
1935 } | |
1936 } | |
1937 | |
1938 /* If we are part of a horizontal combination, advance x for | |
1939 windows to the right of W; otherwise advance y for windows | |
1940 below W. */ | |
1941 if (in_horz_combination_p) | |
1942 x += dim.width; | |
1943 else | |
1944 y += dim.height; | |
1945 | |
1946 /* Remember maximum glyph matrix dimensions. */ | |
1947 wmax = max (wmax, dim.width); | |
1948 hmax = max (hmax, dim.height); | |
1949 | |
1950 /* Next window on same level. */ | |
1951 window = w->next; | |
1952 } | |
1953 while (!NILP (window)); | |
1954 | |
1955 /* Set `total' to the total glyph matrix dimension of this window | |
1956 level. In a vertical combination, the width is the width of the | |
1957 widest window; the height is the y we finally reached, corrected | |
1958 by the y we started with. In a horizontal combination, the total | |
1959 height is the height of the tallest window, and the width is the | |
1960 x we finally reached, corrected by the x we started with. */ | |
1961 if (in_horz_combination_p) | |
1962 { | |
1963 total.width = x - x0; | |
1964 total.height = hmax; | |
1965 } | |
1966 else | |
1967 { | |
1968 total.width = wmax; | |
1969 total.height = y - y0; | |
1970 } | |
1971 | |
1972 return total; | |
1973 } | |
1974 | |
1975 | |
1976 /* Allocate window matrices for window-based redisplay. W is the | |
1977 window whose matrices must be allocated/reallocated. CH_DIM is the | |
1978 size of the smallest character that could potentially be used on W. */ | |
1979 | |
1980 static void | |
1981 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (w, ch_dim) | |
1982 struct window *w; | |
1983 struct dim ch_dim; | |
1984 { | |
1985 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
1986 | |
1987 while (w) | |
314 | 1988 { |
25012 | 1989 if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
1990 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (XWINDOW (w->vchild), ch_dim); | |
1991 else if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
1992 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (XWINDOW (w->hchild), ch_dim); | |
1993 else | |
314 | 1994 { |
25012 | 1995 /* W is a leaf window. */ |
1996 int window_pixel_width = XFLOATINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f); | |
1997 int window_pixel_height = window_box_height (w) + abs (w->vscroll); | |
1998 struct dim dim; | |
1999 | |
2000 /* If matrices are not yet allocated, allocate them now. */ | |
2001 if (w->desired_matrix == NULL) | |
314 | 2002 { |
25012 | 2003 w->desired_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (NULL); |
2004 w->current_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (NULL); | |
314 | 2005 } |
25012 | 2006 |
2007 /* Compute number of glyphs needed in a glyph row. */ | |
2008 dim.width = (((window_pixel_width + ch_dim.width - 1) | |
2009 / ch_dim.width) | |
2010 /* 2 partially visible columns in the text area. */ | |
2011 + 2 | |
2012 /* One partially visible column at the right | |
2013 edge of each marginal area. */ | |
2014 + 1 + 1); | |
2015 | |
2016 /* Compute number of glyph rows needed. */ | |
2017 dim.height = (((window_pixel_height + ch_dim.height - 1) | |
2018 / ch_dim.height) | |
2019 /* One partially visible line at the top and | |
2020 bottom of the window. */ | |
2021 + 2 | |
2022 /* 2 for top and mode line. */ | |
2023 + 2); | |
2024 | |
2025 /* Change matrices. */ | |
2026 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, dim); | |
2027 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, dim); | |
2028 } | |
2029 | |
2030 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
2031 } | |
2032 } | |
2033 | |
2034 | |
2035 /* Re-allocate/ re-compute glyph matrices on frame F. If F is null, | |
2036 do it for all frames; otherwise do it just for the given frame. | |
2037 This function must be called when a new frame is created, its size | |
2038 changes, or its window configuration changes. */ | |
2039 | |
2040 void | |
2041 adjust_glyphs (f) | |
2042 struct frame *f; | |
2043 { | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
2044 /* Block input so that expose events and other events that access |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
2045 glyph matrices are not processed while we are changing them. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
2046 BLOCK_INPUT; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
2047 |
25012 | 2048 if (f) |
2049 adjust_frame_glyphs (f); | |
2050 else | |
2051 { | |
2052 Lisp_Object tail, lisp_frame; | |
2053 | |
2054 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, lisp_frame) | |
2055 adjust_frame_glyphs (XFRAME (lisp_frame)); | |
2056 } | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
2057 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
2058 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
25012 | 2059 } |
2060 | |
2061 | |
2062 /* Adjust frame glyphs when Emacs is initialized. | |
2063 | |
2064 To be called from init_display. | |
2065 | |
2066 We need a glyph matrix because redraw will happen soon. | |
2067 Unfortunately, window sizes on selected_frame are not yet set to | |
2068 meaningful values. I believe we can assume that there are only two | |
2069 windows on the frame---the mini-buffer and the root window. Frame | |
2070 height and width seem to be correct so far. So, set the sizes of | |
2071 windows to estimated values. */ | |
2072 | |
2073 static void | |
2074 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially () | |
2075 { | |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2076 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME (); |
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2077 struct window *root = XWINDOW (sf->root_window); |
25012 | 2078 struct window *mini = XWINDOW (root->next); |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2079 int frame_height = FRAME_HEIGHT (sf); |
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2080 int frame_width = FRAME_WIDTH (sf); |
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2081 int top_margin = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (sf); |
25012 | 2082 |
2083 /* Do it for the root window. */ | |
2084 XSETFASTINT (root->top, top_margin); | |
2085 XSETFASTINT (root->width, frame_width); | |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2086 set_window_height (sf->root_window, frame_height - 1 - top_margin, 0); |
25012 | 2087 |
2088 /* Do it for the mini-buffer window. */ | |
2089 XSETFASTINT (mini->top, frame_height - 1); | |
2090 XSETFASTINT (mini->width, frame_width); | |
2091 set_window_height (root->next, 1, 0); | |
2092 | |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2093 adjust_frame_glyphs (sf); |
25012 | 2094 glyphs_initialized_initially_p = 1; |
2095 } | |
2096 | |
2097 | |
2098 /* Allocate/reallocate glyph matrices of a single frame F. */ | |
2099 | |
2100 static void | |
2101 adjust_frame_glyphs (f) | |
2102 struct frame *f; | |
2103 { | |
2104 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) | |
2105 adjust_frame_glyphs_for_window_redisplay (f); | |
2106 else | |
2107 adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay (f); | |
2108 | |
2109 /* Don't forget the message buffer and the buffer for | |
2110 decode_mode_spec. */ | |
2111 adjust_frame_message_buffer (f); | |
2112 adjust_decode_mode_spec_buffer (f); | |
2113 | |
2114 f->glyphs_initialized_p = 1; | |
2115 } | |
2116 | |
2117 | |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2118 /* In the window tree with root W, build current matrices of leaf |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2119 windows from the frame's current matrix. */ |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2120 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2121 static void |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2122 fake_current_matrices (window) |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2123 Lisp_Object window; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2124 { |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2125 struct window *w; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2126 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2127 for (; !NILP (window); window = w->next) |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2128 { |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2129 w = XWINDOW (window); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2130 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2131 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2132 fake_current_matrices (w->hchild); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2133 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2134 fake_current_matrices (w->vchild); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2135 else |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2136 { |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2137 int i; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2138 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2139 struct glyph_matrix *m = w->current_matrix; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2140 struct glyph_matrix *fm = f->current_matrix; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2141 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2142 xassert (m->matrix_h == XFASTINT (w->height)); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2143 xassert (m->matrix_w == XFASTINT (w->width)); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2144 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2145 for (i = 0; i < m->matrix_h; ++i) |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2146 { |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2147 struct glyph_row *r = m->rows + i; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2148 struct glyph_row *fr = fm->rows + i + XFASTINT (w->top); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2149 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2150 xassert (r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] >= fr->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2151 && r->glyphs[LAST_AREA] <= fr->glyphs[LAST_AREA]); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2152 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2153 r->enabled_p = fr->enabled_p; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2154 if (r->enabled_p) |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2155 { |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2156 r->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = m->left_margin_glyphs; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2157 r->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = m->right_margin_glyphs; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2158 r->used[TEXT_AREA] = (m->matrix_w |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2159 - r->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2160 - r->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2161 r->mode_line_p = 0; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2162 r->inverse_p = fr->inverse_p; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2163 } |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2164 } |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2165 } |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2166 } |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2167 } |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2168 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2169 |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2170 /* Save away the contents of frame F's current frame matrix. Value is |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2171 a glyph matrix holding the contents of F's current frame matrix. '*/ |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2172 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2173 static struct glyph_matrix * |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2174 save_current_matrix (f) |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2175 struct frame *f; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2176 { |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2177 int i; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2178 struct glyph_matrix *saved; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2179 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2180 saved = (struct glyph_matrix *) xmalloc (sizeof *saved); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2181 bzero (saved, sizeof *saved); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2182 saved->nrows = f->current_matrix->nrows; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2183 saved->rows = (struct glyph_row *) xmalloc (saved->nrows |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2184 * sizeof *saved->rows); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2185 bzero (saved->rows, saved->nrows * sizeof *saved->rows); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2186 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2187 for (i = 0; i < saved->nrows; ++i) |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2188 { |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2189 struct glyph_row *from = f->current_matrix->rows + i; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2190 struct glyph_row *to = saved->rows + i; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2191 size_t nbytes = from->used[TEXT_AREA] * sizeof (struct glyph); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2192 to->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = (struct glyph *) xmalloc (nbytes); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2193 bcopy (from->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], to->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], nbytes); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2194 to->used[TEXT_AREA] = from->used[TEXT_AREA]; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2195 } |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2196 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2197 return saved; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2198 } |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2199 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2200 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2201 /* Restore the contents of frame F's current frame matrix from SAVED, |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2202 and free memory associated with SAVED. */ |
34849
eac70be4cb58
(save_frame_matrix, restore_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34788
diff
changeset
|
2203 |
eac70be4cb58
(save_frame_matrix, restore_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34788
diff
changeset
|
2204 static void |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2205 restore_current_matrix (f, saved) |
34849
eac70be4cb58
(save_frame_matrix, restore_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34788
diff
changeset
|
2206 struct frame *f; |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2207 struct glyph_matrix *saved; |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2208 { |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2209 int i; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2210 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2211 for (i = 0; i < saved->nrows; ++i) |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2212 { |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2213 struct glyph_row *from = saved->rows + i; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2214 struct glyph_row *to = f->current_matrix->rows + i; |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2215 size_t nbytes = from->used[TEXT_AREA] * sizeof (struct glyph); |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2216 bcopy (from->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], to->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], nbytes); |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2217 to->used[TEXT_AREA] = from->used[TEXT_AREA]; |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2218 xfree (from->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]); |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2219 } |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2220 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2221 xfree (saved->rows); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2222 xfree (saved); |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2223 } |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2224 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2225 |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2226 |
25012 | 2227 /* Allocate/reallocate glyph matrices of a single frame F for |
2228 frame-based redisplay. */ | |
2229 | |
2230 static void | |
2231 adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay (f) | |
2232 struct frame *f; | |
2233 { | |
2234 struct dim ch_dim; | |
2235 struct dim matrix_dim; | |
2236 int pool_changed_p; | |
2237 int window_change_flags; | |
2238 int top_window_y; | |
2239 | |
2240 if (!FRAME_LIVE_P (f)) | |
2241 return; | |
2242 | |
2243 /* Determine the smallest character in any font for F. On | |
2244 console windows, all characters have dimension (1, 1). */ | |
2245 ch_dim.width = ch_dim.height = 1; | |
2246 | |
2247 top_window_y = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f); | |
2248 | |
2249 /* Allocate glyph pool structures if not already done. */ | |
2250 if (f->desired_pool == NULL) | |
2251 { | |
2252 f->desired_pool = new_glyph_pool (); | |
2253 f->current_pool = new_glyph_pool (); | |
2254 } | |
2255 | |
2256 /* Allocate frames matrix structures if needed. */ | |
2257 if (f->desired_matrix == NULL) | |
2258 { | |
2259 f->desired_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (f->desired_pool); | |
2260 f->current_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (f->current_pool); | |
2261 } | |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2262 |
25012 | 2263 /* Compute window glyph matrices. (This takes the mini-buffer |
2264 window into account). The result is the size of the frame glyph | |
2265 matrix needed. The variable window_change_flags is set to a bit | |
2266 mask indicating whether new matrices will be allocated or | |
2267 existing matrices change their size or location within the frame | |
2268 matrix. */ | |
2269 window_change_flags = 0; | |
2270 matrix_dim | |
2271 = allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), | |
2272 0, top_window_y, | |
2273 ch_dim, 1, | |
2274 &window_change_flags); | |
2275 | |
2276 /* Add in menu bar lines, if any. */ | |
2277 matrix_dim.height += top_window_y; | |
2278 | |
2279 /* Enlarge pools as necessary. */ | |
2280 pool_changed_p = realloc_glyph_pool (f->desired_pool, matrix_dim); | |
2281 realloc_glyph_pool (f->current_pool, matrix_dim); | |
2282 | |
2283 /* Set up glyph pointers within window matrices. Do this only if | |
2284 absolutely necessary since it requires a frame redraw. */ | |
2285 if (pool_changed_p || window_change_flags) | |
2286 { | |
2287 /* Do it for window matrices. */ | |
2288 allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), | |
2289 0, top_window_y, ch_dim, 0, | |
2290 &window_change_flags); | |
2291 | |
2292 /* Size of frame matrices must equal size of frame. Note | |
2293 that we are called for X frames with window widths NOT equal | |
2294 to the frame width (from CHANGE_FRAME_SIZE_1). */ | |
2295 xassert (matrix_dim.width == FRAME_WIDTH (f) | |
2296 && matrix_dim.height == FRAME_HEIGHT (f)); | |
2297 | |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2298 /* Pointers to glyph memory in glyph rows are exchanged during |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2299 the update phase of redisplay, which means in general that a |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2300 frame's current matrix consists of pointers into both the |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2301 desired and current glyph pool of the frame. Adjusting a |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2302 matrix sets the frame matrix up so that pointers are all into |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2303 the same pool. If we want to preserve glyph contents of the |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2304 current matrix over a call to adjust_glyph_matrix, we must |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2305 make a copy of the current glyphs, and restore the current |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2306 matrix' contents from that copy. */ |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2307 if (display_completed |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2308 && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f) |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2309 && matrix_dim.width == f->current_matrix->matrix_w |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2310 && matrix_dim.height == f->current_matrix->matrix_h) |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2311 { |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2312 struct glyph_matrix *copy = save_current_matrix (f); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2313 adjust_glyph_matrix (NULL, f->desired_matrix, 0, 0, matrix_dim); |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2314 adjust_glyph_matrix (NULL, f->current_matrix, 0, 0, matrix_dim); |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2315 restore_current_matrix (f, copy); |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2316 fake_current_matrices (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)); |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2317 } |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2318 else |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2319 { |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2320 adjust_glyph_matrix (NULL, f->desired_matrix, 0, 0, matrix_dim); |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2321 adjust_glyph_matrix (NULL, f->current_matrix, 0, 0, matrix_dim); |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2322 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2323 } |
25012 | 2324 } |
2325 } | |
2326 | |
2327 | |
2328 /* Allocate/reallocate glyph matrices of a single frame F for | |
2329 window-based redisplay. */ | |
2330 | |
2331 static void | |
2332 adjust_frame_glyphs_for_window_redisplay (f) | |
2333 struct frame *f; | |
2334 { | |
2335 struct dim ch_dim; | |
2336 struct window *w; | |
2337 | |
2338 xassert (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && FRAME_LIVE_P (f)); | |
2339 | |
2340 /* Get minimum sizes. */ | |
2341 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM | |
2342 ch_dim.width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f); | |
2343 ch_dim.height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f); | |
2344 #else | |
2345 ch_dim.width = ch_dim.height = 1; | |
2346 #endif | |
2347 | |
2348 /* Allocate/reallocate window matrices. */ | |
2349 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)), | |
2350 ch_dim); | |
2351 | |
2352 /* Allocate/ reallocate matrices of the dummy window used to display | |
2353 the menu bar under X when no X toolkit support is available. */ | |
2354 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT | |
2355 { | |
2356 /* Allocate a dummy window if not already done. */ | |
2357 if (NILP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
2358 { | |
2359 f->menu_bar_window = make_window (); | |
2360 w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window); | |
2361 XSETFRAME (w->frame, f); | |
2362 w->pseudo_window_p = 1; | |
2363 } | |
2364 else | |
2365 w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window); | |
2366 | |
2367 /* Set window dimensions to frame dimensions and allocate or | |
2368 adjust glyph matrices of W. */ | |
2369 XSETFASTINT (w->top, 0); | |
2370 XSETFASTINT (w->left, 0); | |
2371 XSETFASTINT (w->height, FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f)); | |
2372 XSETFASTINT (w->width, FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)); | |
2373 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (w, ch_dim); | |
2374 } | |
2375 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */ | |
2376 | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2377 /* Allocate/ reallocate matrices of the tool bar window. If we |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2378 don't have a tool bar window yet, make one. */ |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2379 if (NILP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
25012 | 2380 { |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2381 f->tool_bar_window = make_window (); |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2382 w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window); |
25012 | 2383 XSETFRAME (w->frame, f); |
2384 w->pseudo_window_p = 1; | |
2385 } | |
2386 else | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2387 w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window); |
25012 | 2388 |
2389 XSETFASTINT (w->top, FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f)); | |
2390 XSETFASTINT (w->left, 0); | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2391 XSETFASTINT (w->height, FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f)); |
25012 | 2392 XSETFASTINT (w->width, FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)); |
2393 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (w, ch_dim); | |
2394 } | |
2395 | |
2396 | |
2397 /* Adjust/ allocate message buffer of frame F. | |
2398 | |
2399 Note that the message buffer is never freed. Since I could not | |
2400 find a free in 19.34, I assume that freeing it would be | |
2401 problematic in some way and don't do it either. | |
2402 | |
2403 (Implementation note: It should be checked if we can free it | |
2404 eventually without causing trouble). */ | |
2405 | |
2406 static void | |
2407 adjust_frame_message_buffer (f) | |
2408 struct frame *f; | |
2409 { | |
2410 int size = FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) + 1; | |
2411 | |
2412 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f)) | |
2413 { | |
2414 char *buffer = FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f); | |
2415 char *new_buffer = (char *) xrealloc (buffer, size); | |
2416 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f) = new_buffer; | |
2417 } | |
2418 else | |
2419 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f) = (char *) xmalloc (size); | |
2420 } | |
2421 | |
2422 | |
2423 /* Re-allocate buffer for decode_mode_spec on frame F. */ | |
2424 | |
2425 static void | |
2426 adjust_decode_mode_spec_buffer (f) | |
2427 struct frame *f; | |
2428 { | |
2429 f->decode_mode_spec_buffer | |
2430 = (char *) xrealloc (f->decode_mode_spec_buffer, | |
2431 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) + 1); | |
2432 } | |
2433 | |
2434 | |
2435 | |
2436 /********************************************************************** | |
2437 Freeing Glyph Matrices | |
2438 **********************************************************************/ | |
2439 | |
2440 /* Free glyph memory for a frame F. F may be null. This function can | |
2441 be called for the same frame more than once. The root window of | |
2442 F may be nil when this function is called. This is the case when | |
2443 the function is called when F is destroyed. */ | |
2444 | |
2445 void | |
2446 free_glyphs (f) | |
2447 struct frame *f; | |
2448 { | |
2449 if (f && f->glyphs_initialized_p) | |
2450 { | |
27968
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2451 /* Block interrupt input so that we don't get surprised by an X |
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2452 event while we're in an inconsistent state. */ |
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2453 BLOCK_INPUT; |
25012 | 2454 f->glyphs_initialized_p = 0; |
2455 | |
2456 /* Release window sub-matrices. */ | |
2457 if (!NILP (f->root_window)) | |
2458 free_window_matrices (XWINDOW (f->root_window)); | |
2459 | |
2460 /* Free the dummy window for menu bars without X toolkit and its | |
2461 glyph matrices. */ | |
2462 if (!NILP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
2463 { | |
2464 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window); | |
2465 free_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix); | |
2466 free_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix); | |
2467 w->desired_matrix = w->current_matrix = NULL; | |
2468 f->menu_bar_window = Qnil; | |
2469 } | |
2470 | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2471 /* Free the tool bar window and its glyph matrices. */ |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2472 if (!NILP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
25012 | 2473 { |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2474 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window); |
25012 | 2475 free_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix); |
2476 free_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix); | |
2477 w->desired_matrix = w->current_matrix = NULL; | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2478 f->tool_bar_window = Qnil; |
25012 | 2479 } |
2480 | |
2481 /* Release frame glyph matrices. Reset fields to zero in | |
2482 case we are called a second time. */ | |
2483 if (f->desired_matrix) | |
2484 { | |
2485 free_glyph_matrix (f->desired_matrix); | |
2486 free_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix); | |
2487 f->desired_matrix = f->current_matrix = NULL; | |
2488 } | |
2489 | |
2490 /* Release glyph pools. */ | |
2491 if (f->desired_pool) | |
2492 { | |
2493 free_glyph_pool (f->desired_pool); | |
2494 free_glyph_pool (f->current_pool); | |
2495 f->desired_pool = f->current_pool = NULL; | |
314 | 2496 } |
27968
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2497 |
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2498 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
314 | 2499 } |
2500 } | |
2501 | |
25012 | 2502 |
2503 /* Free glyph sub-matrices in the window tree rooted at W. This | |
2504 function may be called with a null pointer, and it may be called on | |
2505 the same tree more than once. */ | |
2506 | |
2507 void | |
2508 free_window_matrices (w) | |
2509 struct window *w; | |
2510 { | |
2511 while (w) | |
2512 { | |
2513 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
2514 free_window_matrices (XWINDOW (w->hchild)); | |
2515 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
2516 free_window_matrices (XWINDOW (w->vchild)); | |
2517 else | |
2518 { | |
2519 /* This is a leaf window. Free its memory and reset fields | |
2520 to zero in case this function is called a second time for | |
2521 W. */ | |
2522 free_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix); | |
2523 free_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix); | |
2524 w->current_matrix = w->desired_matrix = NULL; | |
2525 } | |
2526 | |
2527 /* Next window on same level. */ | |
2528 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
2529 } | |
2530 } | |
2531 | |
2532 | |
2533 /* Check glyph memory leaks. This function is called from | |
2534 shut_down_emacs. Note that frames are not destroyed when Emacs | |
2535 exits. We therefore free all glyph memory for all active frames | |
2536 explicitly and check that nothing is left allocated. */ | |
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2537 |
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2538 void |
25012 | 2539 check_glyph_memory () |
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2540 { |
25012 | 2541 Lisp_Object tail, frame; |
2542 | |
2543 /* Free glyph memory for all frames. */ | |
2544 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
2545 free_glyphs (XFRAME (frame)); | |
2546 | |
2547 /* Check that nothing is left allocated. */ | |
2548 if (glyph_matrix_count) | |
2549 abort (); | |
2550 if (glyph_pool_count) | |
2551 abort (); | |
2552 } | |
2553 | |
2554 | |
2555 | |
2556 /********************************************************************** | |
2557 Building a Frame Matrix | |
2558 **********************************************************************/ | |
2559 | |
2560 /* Most of the redisplay code works on glyph matrices attached to | |
2561 windows. This is a good solution most of the time, but it is not | |
2562 suitable for terminal code. Terminal output functions cannot rely | |
2563 on being able to set an arbitrary terminal window. Instead they | |
2564 must be provided with a view of the whole frame, i.e. the whole | |
2565 screen. We build such a view by constructing a frame matrix from | |
2566 window matrices in this section. | |
2567 | |
2568 Windows that must be updated have their must_be_update_p flag set. | |
2569 For all such windows, their desired matrix is made part of the | |
2570 desired frame matrix. For other windows, their current matrix is | |
2571 made part of the desired frame matrix. | |
2572 | |
2573 +-----------------+----------------+ | |
2574 | desired | desired | | |
2575 | | | | |
2576 +-----------------+----------------+ | |
2577 | current | | |
2578 | | | |
2579 +----------------------------------+ | |
2580 | |
2581 Desired window matrices can be made part of the frame matrix in a | |
2582 cheap way: We exploit the fact that the desired frame matrix and | |
2583 desired window matrices share their glyph memory. This is not | |
2584 possible for current window matrices. Their glyphs are copied to | |
2585 the desired frame matrix. The latter is equivalent to | |
2586 preserve_other_columns in the old redisplay. | |
2587 | |
2588 Used glyphs counters for frame matrix rows are the result of adding | |
2589 up glyph lengths of the window matrices. A line in the frame | |
2590 matrix is enabled, if a corresponding line in a window matrix is | |
2591 enabled. | |
2592 | |
2593 After building the desired frame matrix, it will be passed to | |
2594 terminal code, which will manipulate both the desired and current | |
2595 frame matrix. Changes applied to the frame's current matrix have | |
2596 to be visible in current window matrices afterwards, of course. | |
2597 | |
2598 This problem is solved like this: | |
2599 | |
2600 1. Window and frame matrices share glyphs. Window matrices are | |
2601 constructed in a way that their glyph contents ARE the glyph | |
2602 contents needed in a frame matrix. Thus, any modification of | |
2603 glyphs done in terminal code will be reflected in window matrices | |
2604 automatically. | |
2605 | |
2606 2. Exchanges of rows in a frame matrix done by terminal code are | |
2607 intercepted by hook functions so that corresponding row operations | |
2608 on window matrices can be performed. This is necessary because we | |
2609 use pointers to glyphs in glyph row structures. To satisfy the | |
2610 assumption of point 1 above that glyphs are updated implicitly in | |
2611 window matrices when they are manipulated via the frame matrix, | |
2612 window and frame matrix must of course agree where to find the | |
2613 glyphs for their rows. Possible manipulations that must be | |
2614 mirrored are assignments of rows of the desired frame matrix to the | |
2615 current frame matrix and scrolling the current frame matrix. */ | |
2616 | |
2617 /* Build frame F's desired matrix from window matrices. Only windows | |
2618 which have the flag must_be_updated_p set have to be updated. Menu | |
2619 bar lines of a frame are not covered by window matrices, so make | |
2620 sure not to touch them in this function. */ | |
2621 | |
2622 static void | |
2623 build_frame_matrix (f) | |
2624 struct frame *f; | |
2625 { | |
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2626 int i; |
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2627 |
25012 | 2628 /* F must have a frame matrix when this function is called. */ |
2629 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); | |
2630 | |
2631 /* Clear all rows in the frame matrix covered by window matrices. | |
2632 Menu bar lines are not covered by windows. */ | |
2633 for (i = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f); i < f->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i) | |
2634 clear_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (f->desired_matrix, i)); | |
2635 | |
2636 /* Build the matrix by walking the window tree. */ | |
2637 build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (f->desired_matrix, | |
2638 XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))); | |
2639 } | |
2640 | |
2641 | |
2642 /* Walk a window tree, building a frame matrix MATRIX from window | |
2643 matrices. W is the root of a window tree. */ | |
2644 | |
2645 static void | |
2646 build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (matrix, w) | |
2647 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
2648 struct window *w; | |
2649 { | |
2650 while (w) | |
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2651 { |
25012 | 2652 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
2653 build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (matrix, XWINDOW (w->hchild)); | |
2654 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
2655 build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (matrix, XWINDOW (w->vchild)); | |
2656 else | |
2657 build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window (matrix, w); | |
2658 | |
2659 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2660 } |
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2661 } |
6642
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2662 |
25012 | 2663 |
2664 /* Add a window's matrix to a frame matrix. FRAME_MATRIX is the | |
2665 desired frame matrix built. W is a leaf window whose desired or | |
2666 current matrix is to be added to FRAME_MATRIX. W's flag | |
2667 must_be_updated_p determines which matrix it contributes to | |
2668 FRAME_MATRIX. If must_be_updated_p is non-zero, W's desired matrix | |
2669 is added to FRAME_MATRIX, otherwise W's current matrix is added. | |
2670 Adding a desired matrix means setting up used counters and such in | |
2671 frame rows, while adding a current window matrix to FRAME_MATRIX | |
2672 means copying glyphs. The latter case corresponds to | |
2673 preserve_other_columns in the old redisplay. */ | |
2674 | |
2675 static void | |
2676 build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window (frame_matrix, w) | |
2677 struct glyph_matrix *frame_matrix; | |
6642
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2678 struct window *w; |
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2679 { |
25012 | 2680 struct glyph_matrix *window_matrix; |
2681 int window_y, frame_y; | |
2682 /* If non-zero, a glyph to insert at the right border of W. */ | |
2683 GLYPH right_border_glyph = 0; | |
2684 | |
2685 /* Set window_matrix to the matrix we have to add to FRAME_MATRIX. */ | |
2686 if (w->must_be_updated_p) | |
2687 { | |
2688 window_matrix = w->desired_matrix; | |
2689 | |
2690 /* Decide whether we want to add a vertical border glyph. */ | |
2691 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)) | |
2692 { | |
2693 struct Lisp_Char_Table *dp = window_display_table (w); | |
2694 right_border_glyph = (dp && INTEGERP (DISP_BORDER_GLYPH (dp)) | |
2695 ? XINT (DISP_BORDER_GLYPH (dp)) | |
2696 : '|'); | |
2697 } | |
2698 } | |
2699 else | |
2700 window_matrix = w->current_matrix; | |
2701 | |
2702 /* For all rows in the window matrix and corresponding rows in the | |
2703 frame matrix. */ | |
2704 window_y = 0; | |
2705 frame_y = window_matrix->matrix_y; | |
2706 while (window_y < window_matrix->nrows) | |
6642
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2707 { |
25012 | 2708 struct glyph_row *frame_row = frame_matrix->rows + frame_y; |
2709 struct glyph_row *window_row = window_matrix->rows + window_y; | |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2710 int current_row_p = window_matrix == w->current_matrix; |
25012 | 2711 |
2712 /* Fill up the frame row with spaces up to the left margin of the | |
2713 window row. */ | |
2714 fill_up_frame_row_with_spaces (frame_row, window_matrix->matrix_x); | |
2715 | |
2716 /* Fill up areas in the window matrix row with spaces. */ | |
2717 fill_up_glyph_row_with_spaces (window_row); | |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2718 |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2719 /* If only part of W's desired matrix has been built, and |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2720 window_row wasn't displayed, use the corresponding current |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2721 row instead. */ |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2722 if (window_matrix == w->desired_matrix |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2723 && !window_row->enabled_p) |
6682
16ab14205588
(verify_charstarts): Handle truncation of lines.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6648
diff
changeset
|
2724 { |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2725 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows + window_y; |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2726 current_row_p = 1; |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2727 } |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2728 |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2729 if (current_row_p) |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2730 { |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2731 /* Copy window row to frame row. */ |
25012 | 2732 bcopy (window_row->glyphs[0], |
2733 frame_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + window_matrix->matrix_x, | |
2734 window_matrix->matrix_w * sizeof (struct glyph)); | |
2735 } | |
2736 else | |
2737 { | |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2738 xassert (window_row->enabled_p); |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2739 |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2740 /* Only when a desired row has been displayed, we want |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2741 the corresponding frame row to be updated. */ |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2742 frame_row->enabled_p = 1; |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2743 |
25012 | 2744 /* Maybe insert a vertical border between horizontally adjacent |
2745 windows. */ | |
2746 if (right_border_glyph) | |
2747 { | |
2748 struct glyph *border = window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] - 1; | |
2749 SET_CHAR_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH (*border, right_border_glyph); | |
2750 } | |
2751 | |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2752 /* Window row window_y must be a slice of frame row |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2753 frame_y. */ |
25012 | 2754 xassert (glyph_row_slice_p (window_row, frame_row)); |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2755 |
25012 | 2756 /* If rows are in sync, we don't have to copy glyphs because |
2757 frame and window share glyphs. */ | |
25241
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2758 |
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2759 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2760 strcpy (w->current_matrix->method, w->desired_matrix->method); |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
2761 add_window_display_history (w, w->current_matrix->method, 0); |
25241
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2762 #endif |
25012 | 2763 } |
2764 | |
2765 /* Set number of used glyphs in the frame matrix. Since we fill | |
2766 up with spaces, and visit leaf windows from left to right it | |
2767 can be done simply. */ | |
2768 frame_row->used[TEXT_AREA] | |
2769 = window_matrix->matrix_x + window_matrix->matrix_w; | |
2770 | |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2771 /* Or in other flags. */ |
25012 | 2772 frame_row->inverse_p |= window_row->inverse_p; |
2773 | |
2774 /* Next row. */ | |
2775 ++window_y; | |
2776 ++frame_y; | |
2777 } | |
2778 } | |
2779 | |
2780 | |
2781 /* Add spaces to a glyph row ROW in a window matrix. | |
2782 | |
2783 Each row has the form: | |
2784 | |
2785 +---------+-----------------------------+------------+ | |
2786 | left | text | right | | |
2787 +---------+-----------------------------+------------+ | |
2788 | |
2789 Left and right marginal areas are optional. This function adds | |
2790 spaces to areas so that there are no empty holes between areas. | |
2791 In other words: If the right area is not empty, the text area | |
2792 is filled up with spaces up to the right area. If the text area | |
2793 is not empty, the left area is filled up. | |
2794 | |
2795 To be called for frame-based redisplay, only. */ | |
2796 | |
2797 static void | |
2798 fill_up_glyph_row_with_spaces (row) | |
2799 struct glyph_row *row; | |
2800 { | |
2801 fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA); | |
2802 fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (row, TEXT_AREA); | |
2803 fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA); | |
2804 } | |
2805 | |
2806 | |
2807 /* Fill area AREA of glyph row ROW with spaces. To be called for | |
2808 frame-based redisplay only. */ | |
2809 | |
2810 static void | |
2811 fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (row, area) | |
2812 struct glyph_row *row; | |
2813 int area; | |
2814 { | |
2815 if (row->glyphs[area] < row->glyphs[area + 1]) | |
2816 { | |
2817 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area + 1]; | |
2818 struct glyph *text = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area]; | |
2819 | |
2820 while (text < end) | |
2821 *text++ = space_glyph; | |
2822 row->used[area] = text - row->glyphs[area]; | |
2823 } | |
2824 } | |
2825 | |
2826 | |
2827 /* Add spaces to the end of ROW in a frame matrix until index UPTO is | |
2828 reached. In frame matrices only one area, TEXT_AREA, is used. */ | |
2829 | |
2830 static void | |
2831 fill_up_frame_row_with_spaces (row, upto) | |
2832 struct glyph_row *row; | |
2833 int upto; | |
2834 { | |
2835 int i = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
2836 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
2837 | |
2838 while (i < upto) | |
2839 glyph[i++] = space_glyph; | |
2840 | |
2841 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i; | |
2842 } | |
2843 | |
2844 | |
2845 | |
2846 /********************************************************************** | |
2847 Mirroring operations on frame matrices in window matrices | |
2848 **********************************************************************/ | |
2849 | |
2850 /* Set frame being updated via frame-based redisplay to F. This | |
2851 function must be called before updates to make explicit that we are | |
2852 working on frame matrices or not. */ | |
2853 | |
2854 static INLINE void | |
2855 set_frame_matrix_frame (f) | |
2856 struct frame *f; | |
2857 { | |
2858 frame_matrix_frame = f; | |
2859 } | |
2860 | |
2861 | |
2862 /* Make sure glyph row ROW in CURRENT_MATRIX is up to date. | |
2863 DESIRED_MATRIX is the desired matrix corresponding to | |
2864 CURRENT_MATRIX. The update is done by exchanging glyph pointers | |
2865 between rows in CURRENT_MATRIX and DESIRED_MATRIX. If | |
2866 frame_matrix_frame is non-null, this indicates that the exchange is | |
2867 done in frame matrices, and that we have to perform analogous | |
2868 operations in window matrices of frame_matrix_frame. */ | |
2869 | |
2870 static INLINE void | |
2871 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, row) | |
2872 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix, *current_matrix; | |
2873 int row; | |
2874 { | |
2875 struct glyph_row *current_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, row); | |
2876 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, row); | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
2877 int mouse_face_p = current_row->mouse_face_p; |
25012 | 2878 |
2879 /* Do current_row = desired_row. This exchanges glyph pointers | |
2880 between both rows, and does a structure assignment otherwise. */ | |
2881 assign_row (current_row, desired_row); | |
2882 | |
2883 /* Enable current_row to mark it as valid. */ | |
2884 current_row->enabled_p = 1; | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
2885 current_row->mouse_face_p = mouse_face_p; |
25012 | 2886 |
2887 /* If we are called on frame matrices, perform analogous operations | |
2888 for window matrices. */ | |
2889 if (frame_matrix_frame) | |
2890 mirror_make_current (XWINDOW (frame_matrix_frame->root_window), row); | |
2891 } | |
2892 | |
2893 | |
2894 /* W is the root of a window tree. FRAME_ROW is the index of a row in | |
2895 W's frame which has been made current (by swapping pointers between | |
2896 current and desired matrix). Perform analogous operations in the | |
2897 matrices of leaf windows in the window tree rooted at W. */ | |
2898 | |
2899 static void | |
2900 mirror_make_current (w, frame_row) | |
2901 struct window *w; | |
2902 int frame_row; | |
2903 { | |
2904 while (w) | |
2905 { | |
2906 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
2907 mirror_make_current (XWINDOW (w->hchild), frame_row); | |
2908 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
2909 mirror_make_current (XWINDOW (w->vchild), frame_row); | |
2910 else | |
2911 { | |
2912 /* Row relative to window W. Don't use FRAME_TO_WINDOW_VPOS | |
2913 here because the checks performed in debug mode there | |
2914 will not allow the conversion. */ | |
2915 int row = frame_row - w->desired_matrix->matrix_y; | |
2916 | |
2917 /* If FRAME_ROW is within W, assign the desired row to the | |
2918 current row (exchanging glyph pointers). */ | |
2919 if (row >= 0 && row < w->desired_matrix->matrix_h) | |
6682
16ab14205588
(verify_charstarts): Handle truncation of lines.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6648
diff
changeset
|
2920 { |
25012 | 2921 struct glyph_row *current_row |
2922 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, row); | |
2923 struct glyph_row *desired_row | |
2924 = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, row); | |
25241
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2925 |
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2926 if (desired_row->enabled_p) |
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2927 assign_row (current_row, desired_row); |
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2928 else |
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2929 swap_glyph_pointers (desired_row, current_row); |
25012 | 2930 current_row->enabled_p = 1; |
6682
16ab14205588
(verify_charstarts): Handle truncation of lines.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6648
diff
changeset
|
2931 } |
16ab14205588
(verify_charstarts): Handle truncation of lines.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6648
diff
changeset
|
2932 } |
25012 | 2933 |
2934 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
6642
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2935 } |
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2936 } |
25012 | 2937 |
2938 | |
2939 /* Perform row dance after scrolling. We are working on the range of | |
2940 lines UNCHANGED_AT_TOP + 1 to UNCHANGED_AT_TOP + NLINES (not | |
2941 including) in MATRIX. COPY_FROM is a vector containing, for each | |
2942 row I in the range 0 <= I < NLINES, the index of the original line | |
2943 to move to I. This index is relative to the row range, i.e. 0 <= | |
2944 index < NLINES. RETAINED_P is a vector containing zero for each | |
2945 row 0 <= I < NLINES which is empty. | |
2946 | |
2947 This function is called from do_scrolling and do_direct_scrolling. */ | |
2948 | |
2949 void | |
2950 mirrored_line_dance (matrix, unchanged_at_top, nlines, copy_from, | |
2951 retained_p) | |
2952 struct glyph_matrix *matrix; | |
2953 int unchanged_at_top, nlines; | |
2954 int *copy_from; | |
2955 char *retained_p; | |
2956 { | |
2957 /* A copy of original rows. */ | |
2958 struct glyph_row *old_rows; | |
2959 | |
2960 /* Rows to assign to. */ | |
2961 struct glyph_row *new_rows = MATRIX_ROW (matrix, unchanged_at_top); | |
2962 | |
2963 int i; | |
2964 | |
2965 /* Make a copy of the original rows. */ | |
2966 old_rows = (struct glyph_row *) alloca (nlines * sizeof *old_rows); | |
2967 bcopy (new_rows, old_rows, nlines * sizeof *old_rows); | |
2968 | |
2969 /* Assign new rows, maybe clear lines. */ | |
2970 for (i = 0; i < nlines; ++i) | |
2971 { | |
2972 int enabled_before_p = new_rows[i].enabled_p; | |
2973 | |
2974 xassert (i + unchanged_at_top < matrix->nrows); | |
2975 xassert (unchanged_at_top + copy_from[i] < matrix->nrows); | |
2976 new_rows[i] = old_rows[copy_from[i]]; | |
2977 new_rows[i].enabled_p = enabled_before_p; | |
2978 | |
2979 /* RETAINED_P is zero for empty lines. */ | |
2980 if (!retained_p[copy_from[i]]) | |
2981 new_rows[i].enabled_p = 0; | |
2982 } | |
2983 | |
2984 /* Do the same for window matrices, if MATRIX Is a frame matrix. */ | |
2985 if (frame_matrix_frame) | |
2986 mirror_line_dance (XWINDOW (frame_matrix_frame->root_window), | |
2987 unchanged_at_top, nlines, copy_from, retained_p); | |
2988 } | |
2989 | |
2990 | |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2991 /* Synchronize glyph pointers in the current matrix of window W with |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2992 the current frame matrix. W must be full-width, and be on a tty |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2993 frame. */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2994 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2995 static void |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2996 sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows (w) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2997 struct window *w; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2998 { |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2999 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3000 struct glyph_row *window_row, *window_row_end, *frame_row; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3001 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3002 /* Preconditions: W must be a leaf window and full-width. Its frame |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3003 must have a frame matrix. */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3004 xassert (NILP (w->hchild) && NILP (w->vchild)); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3005 xassert (WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3006 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3007 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3008 /* If W is a full-width window, glyph pointers in W's current matrix |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3009 have, by definition, to be the same as glyph pointers in the |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3010 corresponding frame matrix. */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3011 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3012 window_row_end = window_row + w->current_matrix->nrows; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3013 frame_row = f->current_matrix->rows + XFASTINT (w->top); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3014 while (window_row < window_row_end) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3015 { |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3016 int area; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3017 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3018 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area <= LAST_AREA; ++area) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3019 window_row->glyphs[area] = frame_row->glyphs[area]; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3020 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3021 ++window_row, ++frame_row; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3022 } |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3023 } |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3024 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3025 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3026 /* Return the window in the window tree rooted in W containing frame |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3027 row ROW. Value is null if none is found. */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3028 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3029 struct window * |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3030 frame_row_to_window (w, row) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3031 struct window *w; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3032 int row; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3033 { |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3034 struct window *found = NULL; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3035 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3036 while (w && !found) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3037 { |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3038 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3039 found = frame_row_to_window (XWINDOW (w->hchild), row); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3040 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3041 found = frame_row_to_window (XWINDOW (w->vchild), row); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3042 else if (row >= XFASTINT (w->top) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3043 && row < XFASTINT (w->top) + XFASTINT (w->height)) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3044 found = w; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3045 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3046 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3047 } |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3048 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3049 return found; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3050 } |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3051 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3052 |
25012 | 3053 /* Perform a line dance in the window tree rooted at W, after |
3054 scrolling a frame matrix in mirrored_line_dance. | |
3055 | |
3056 We are working on the range of lines UNCHANGED_AT_TOP + 1 to | |
3057 UNCHANGED_AT_TOP + NLINES (not including) in W's frame matrix. | |
3058 COPY_FROM is a vector containing, for each row I in the range 0 <= | |
3059 I < NLINES, the index of the original line to move to I. This | |
3060 index is relative to the row range, i.e. 0 <= index < NLINES. | |
3061 RETAINED_P is a vector containing zero for each row 0 <= I < NLINES | |
3062 which is empty. */ | |
3063 | |
3064 static void | |
3065 mirror_line_dance (w, unchanged_at_top, nlines, copy_from, retained_p) | |
3066 struct window *w; | |
3067 int unchanged_at_top, nlines; | |
3068 int *copy_from; | |
3069 char *retained_p; | |
3070 { | |
3071 while (w) | |
3072 { | |
3073 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
3074 mirror_line_dance (XWINDOW (w->hchild), unchanged_at_top, | |
3075 nlines, copy_from, retained_p); | |
3076 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
3077 mirror_line_dance (XWINDOW (w->vchild), unchanged_at_top, | |
3078 nlines, copy_from, retained_p); | |
3079 else | |
3080 { | |
3081 /* W is a leaf window, and we are working on its current | |
3082 matrix m. */ | |
3083 struct glyph_matrix *m = w->current_matrix; | |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3084 int i, sync_p = 0; |
25012 | 3085 struct glyph_row *old_rows; |
3086 | |
3087 /* Make a copy of the original rows of matrix m. */ | |
3088 old_rows = (struct glyph_row *) alloca (m->nrows * sizeof *old_rows); | |
3089 bcopy (m->rows, old_rows, m->nrows * sizeof *old_rows); | |
3090 | |
3091 for (i = 0; i < nlines; ++i) | |
3092 { | |
3093 /* Frame relative line assigned to. */ | |
3094 int frame_to = i + unchanged_at_top; | |
3095 | |
3096 /* Frame relative line assigned. */ | |
3097 int frame_from = copy_from[i] + unchanged_at_top; | |
3098 | |
3099 /* Window relative line assigned to. */ | |
3100 int window_to = frame_to - m->matrix_y; | |
3101 | |
3102 /* Window relative line assigned. */ | |
3103 int window_from = frame_from - m->matrix_y; | |
3104 | |
3105 /* Is assigned line inside window? */ | |
3106 int from_inside_window_p | |
3107 = window_from >= 0 && window_from < m->matrix_h; | |
3108 | |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3109 /* Is assigned to line inside window? */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3110 int to_inside_window_p |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3111 = window_to >= 0 && window_to < m->matrix_h; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3112 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3113 if (from_inside_window_p && to_inside_window_p) |
25012 | 3114 { |
3115 /* Enabled setting before assignment. */ | |
3116 int enabled_before_p; | |
3117 | |
3118 /* Do the assignment. The enabled_p flag is saved | |
3119 over the assignment because the old redisplay did | |
3120 that. */ | |
3121 enabled_before_p = m->rows[window_to].enabled_p; | |
3122 m->rows[window_to] = old_rows[window_from]; | |
3123 m->rows[window_to].enabled_p = enabled_before_p; | |
3124 | |
3125 /* If frame line is empty, window line is empty, too. */ | |
3126 if (!retained_p[copy_from[i]]) | |
3127 m->rows[window_to].enabled_p = 0; | |
3128 } | |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3129 else if (to_inside_window_p) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3130 { |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3131 /* A copy between windows. This is an infrequent |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3132 case not worth optimizing. */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3133 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3134 struct window *root = XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3135 struct window *w2; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3136 struct glyph_matrix *m2; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3137 int m2_from; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3138 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3139 w2 = frame_row_to_window (root, frame_to); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3140 m2 = w2->current_matrix; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3141 m2_from = frame_from - m2->matrix_y; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3142 copy_row_except_pointers (m->rows + window_to, |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3143 m2->rows + m2_from); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3144 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3145 /* If frame line is empty, window line is empty, too. */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3146 if (!retained_p[copy_from[i]]) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3147 m->rows[window_to].enabled_p = 0; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3148 sync_p = 1; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3149 } |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3150 else if (from_inside_window_p) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3151 sync_p = 1; |
25012 | 3152 } |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3153 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3154 /* If there was a copy between windows, make sure glyph |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3155 pointers are in sync with the frame matrix. */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3156 if (sync_p) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3157 sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows (w); |
25012 | 3158 |
3159 /* Check that no pointers are lost. */ | |
3160 CHECK_MATRIX (m); | |
3161 } | |
3162 | |
3163 /* Next window on same level. */ | |
3164 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
3165 } | |
3166 } | |
3167 | |
3168 | |
3169 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
3170 | |
3171 /* Check that window and frame matrices agree about their | |
3172 understanding where glyphs of the rows are to find. For each | |
3173 window in the window tree rooted at W, check that rows in the | |
3174 matrices of leaf window agree with their frame matrices about | |
3175 glyph pointers. */ | |
314 | 3176 |
21514 | 3177 void |
25012 | 3178 check_window_matrix_pointers (w) |
314 | 3179 struct window *w; |
3180 { | |
25012 | 3181 while (w) |
3182 { | |
3183 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
3184 check_window_matrix_pointers (XWINDOW (w->hchild)); | |
3185 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
3186 check_window_matrix_pointers (XWINDOW (w->vchild)); | |
3187 else | |
3188 { | |
3189 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
3190 check_matrix_pointers (w->desired_matrix, f->desired_matrix); | |
3191 check_matrix_pointers (w->current_matrix, f->current_matrix); | |
3192 } | |
3193 | |
3194 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
3195 } | |
3196 } | |
3197 | |
3198 | |
3199 /* Check that window rows are slices of frame rows. WINDOW_MATRIX is | |
3200 a window and FRAME_MATRIX is the corresponding frame matrix. For | |
3201 each row in WINDOW_MATRIX check that it's a slice of the | |
3202 corresponding frame row. If it isn't, abort. */ | |
3203 | |
3204 static void | |
3205 check_matrix_pointers (window_matrix, frame_matrix) | |
3206 struct glyph_matrix *window_matrix, *frame_matrix; | |
3207 { | |
3208 /* Row number in WINDOW_MATRIX. */ | |
3209 int i = 0; | |
3210 | |
3211 /* Row number corresponding to I in FRAME_MATRIX. */ | |
3212 int j = window_matrix->matrix_y; | |
3213 | |
3214 /* For all rows check that the row in the window matrix is a | |
3215 slice of the row in the frame matrix. If it isn't we didn't | |
3216 mirror an operation on the frame matrix correctly. */ | |
3217 while (i < window_matrix->nrows) | |
3218 { | |
3219 if (!glyph_row_slice_p (window_matrix->rows + i, | |
3220 frame_matrix->rows + j)) | |
3221 abort (); | |
3222 ++i, ++j; | |
3223 } | |
3224 } | |
3225 | |
3226 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */ | |
3227 | |
3228 | |
3229 | |
3230 /********************************************************************** | |
3231 VPOS and HPOS translations | |
3232 **********************************************************************/ | |
3233 | |
3234 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
3235 | |
3236 /* Translate vertical position VPOS which is relative to window W to a | |
3237 vertical position relative to W's frame. */ | |
3238 | |
3239 static int | |
3240 window_to_frame_vpos (w, vpos) | |
3241 struct window *w; | |
3242 int vpos; | |
3243 { | |
3244 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
3245 | |
3246 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); | |
3247 xassert (vpos >= 0 && vpos <= w->desired_matrix->nrows); | |
3248 vpos += XFASTINT (w->top); | |
3249 xassert (vpos >= 0 && vpos <= FRAME_HEIGHT (f)); | |
3250 return vpos; | |
3251 } | |
3252 | |
3253 | |
3254 /* Translate horizontal position HPOS which is relative to window W to | |
3255 a vertical position relative to W's frame. */ | |
3256 | |
3257 static int | |
3258 window_to_frame_hpos (w, hpos) | |
3259 struct window *w; | |
3260 int hpos; | |
3261 { | |
3262 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
3263 | |
3264 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); | |
3265 hpos += XFASTINT (w->left); | |
3266 return hpos; | |
314 | 3267 } |
25012 | 3268 |
3269 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */ | |
3270 | |
3271 | |
314 | 3272 |
25012 | 3273 /********************************************************************** |
3274 Redrawing Frames | |
3275 **********************************************************************/ | |
3276 | |
3277 DEFUN ("redraw-frame", Fredraw_frame, Sredraw_frame, 1, 1, 0, | |
3278 "Clear frame FRAME and output again what is supposed to appear on it.") | |
3279 (frame) | |
3280 Lisp_Object frame; | |
3281 { | |
3282 struct frame *f; | |
3283 | |
3284 CHECK_LIVE_FRAME (frame, 0); | |
3285 f = XFRAME (frame); | |
3286 | |
3287 /* Ignore redraw requests, if frame has no glyphs yet. | |
3288 (Implementation note: It still has to be checked why we are | |
3289 called so early here). */ | |
3290 if (!glyphs_initialized_initially_p) | |
3291 return Qnil; | |
3292 | |
3293 update_begin (f); | |
35445
9af454aee182
(Fredraw_frame): Remove reference to
Andrew Innes <andrewi@gnu.org>
parents:
35374
diff
changeset
|
3294 if (FRAME_MSDOS_P (f)) |
25012 | 3295 set_terminal_modes (); |
3296 clear_frame (); | |
3297 clear_current_matrices (f); | |
3298 update_end (f); | |
3299 fflush (stdout); | |
3300 windows_or_buffers_changed++; | |
3301 /* Mark all windows as inaccurate, so that every window will have | |
3302 its redisplay done. */ | |
3303 mark_window_display_accurate (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), 0); | |
3304 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)), 1); | |
3305 f->garbaged = 0; | |
3306 return Qnil; | |
3307 } | |
3308 | |
3309 | |
3310 /* Redraw frame F. This is nothing more than a call to the Lisp | |
3311 function redraw-frame. */ | |
3312 | |
3313 void | |
3314 redraw_frame (f) | |
3315 struct frame *f; | |
3316 { | |
3317 Lisp_Object frame; | |
3318 XSETFRAME (frame, f); | |
3319 Fredraw_frame (frame); | |
3320 } | |
3321 | |
3322 | |
3323 DEFUN ("redraw-display", Fredraw_display, Sredraw_display, 0, 0, "", | |
3324 "Clear and redisplay all visible frames.") | |
3325 () | |
3326 { | |
3327 Lisp_Object tail, frame; | |
3328 | |
3329 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
3330 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (frame))) | |
3331 Fredraw_frame (frame); | |
3332 | |
3333 return Qnil; | |
3334 } | |
3335 | |
3336 | |
3337 /* This is used when frame_garbaged is set. Call Fredraw_frame on all | |
3338 visible frames marked as garbaged. */ | |
3339 | |
3340 void | |
3341 redraw_garbaged_frames () | |
3342 { | |
3343 Lisp_Object tail, frame; | |
3344 | |
3345 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
3346 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (frame)) | |
3347 && FRAME_GARBAGED_P (XFRAME (frame))) | |
3348 Fredraw_frame (frame); | |
3349 } | |
3350 | |
3351 | |
3352 | |
3353 /*********************************************************************** | |
3354 Direct Operations | |
3355 ***********************************************************************/ | |
3356 | |
3357 /* Try to update display and current glyph matrix directly. | |
3358 | |
3359 This function is called after a character G has been inserted into | |
3360 current_buffer. It tries to update the current glyph matrix and | |
3361 perform appropriate screen output to reflect the insertion. If it | |
3362 succeeds, the global flag redisplay_performed_directly_p will be | |
3363 set to 1, and thereby prevent the more costly general redisplay | |
3364 from running (see redisplay_internal). | |
3365 | |
3366 This function is not called for `hairy' character insertions. | |
3367 In particular, it is not called when after or before change | |
3368 functions exist, like they are used by font-lock. See keyboard.c | |
3369 for details where this function is called. */ | |
314 | 3370 |
3371 int | |
3372 direct_output_for_insert (g) | |
3373 int g; | |
3374 { | |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
3375 register struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME (); |
25012 | 3376 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window); |
3377 struct it it, it2; | |
3378 struct glyph_row *glyph_row; | |
3379 struct glyph *glyphs, *glyph, *end; | |
3380 int n; | |
3381 /* Non-null means that Redisplay of W is based on window matrices. */ | |
3382 int window_redisplay_p = FRAME_WINDOW_P (f); | |
3383 /* Non-null means we are in overwrite mode. */ | |
3384 int overwrite_p = !NILP (current_buffer->overwrite_mode); | |
3385 int added_width; | |
3386 struct text_pos pos; | |
3387 int delta, delta_bytes; | |
3388 | |
3389 /* Not done directly. */ | |
3390 redisplay_performed_directly_p = 0; | |
3391 | |
3392 /* Quickly give up for some common cases. */ | |
3393 if (cursor_in_echo_area | |
3394 /* Give up if fonts have changed. */ | |
3395 || fonts_changed_p | |
3396 /* Give up if face attributes have been changed. */ | |
3397 || face_change_count | |
3398 /* Give up if cursor position not really known. */ | |
314 | 3399 || !display_completed |
25012 | 3400 /* Give up if buffer appears in two places. */ |
314 | 3401 || buffer_shared > 1 |
34715
fc3693bea815
(direct_output_for_insert): Fix check for mini-window
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34622
diff
changeset
|
3402 /* Give up if currently displaying a message instead of the |
fc3693bea815
(direct_output_for_insert): Fix check for mini-window
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34622
diff
changeset
|
3403 minibuffer contents. */ |
fc3693bea815
(direct_output_for_insert): Fix check for mini-window
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34622
diff
changeset
|
3404 || (EQ (selected_window, minibuf_window) |
fc3693bea815
(direct_output_for_insert): Fix check for mini-window
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34622
diff
changeset
|
3405 && EQ (minibuf_window, echo_area_window)) |
25012 | 3406 /* Give up for hscrolled mini-buffer because display of the prompt |
3407 is handled specially there (see display_line). */ | |
3408 || (MINI_WINDOW_P (w) && XFASTINT (w->hscroll)) | |
3409 /* Give up if overwriting in the middle of a line. */ | |
3410 || (overwrite_p | |
3411 && PT != ZV | |
3412 && FETCH_BYTE (PT) != '\n') | |
3413 /* Give up for tabs and line ends. */ | |
3414 || g == '\t' | |
3415 || g == '\n' | |
3416 || g == '\r' | |
3417 /* Give up if unable to display the cursor in the window. */ | |
3418 || w->cursor.vpos < 0 | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3419 || (glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos), |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3420 /* Can't do it in a continued line because continuation |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3421 lines would change. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3422 (glyph_row->continued_p |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3423 /* Can't use this method if the line overlaps others or is |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3424 overlapped by others because these other lines would |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3425 have to be redisplayed. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3426 || glyph_row->overlapping_p |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3427 || glyph_row->overlapped_p)) |
25012 | 3428 /* Can't do it for partial width windows on terminal frames |
3429 because we can't clear to eol in such a window. */ | |
3430 || (!window_redisplay_p && !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w))) | |
3431 return 0; | |
3432 | |
35374
3fc8f4c6ed56
(direct_output_for_insert): If char_ins_del_ok is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35336
diff
changeset
|
3433 /* If we can't insert glyphs, we can use this method only |
3fc8f4c6ed56
(direct_output_for_insert): If char_ins_del_ok is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35336
diff
changeset
|
3434 at the end of a line. */ |
3fc8f4c6ed56
(direct_output_for_insert): If char_ins_del_ok is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35336
diff
changeset
|
3435 if (!char_ins_del_ok) |
3fc8f4c6ed56
(direct_output_for_insert): If char_ins_del_ok is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35336
diff
changeset
|
3436 if (PT != ZV && FETCH_BYTE (PT_BYTE) != '\n') |
3fc8f4c6ed56
(direct_output_for_insert): If char_ins_del_ok is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35336
diff
changeset
|
3437 return 0; |
3fc8f4c6ed56
(direct_output_for_insert): If char_ins_del_ok is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35336
diff
changeset
|
3438 |
25012 | 3439 /* Set up a display iterator structure for W. Glyphs will be |
3440 produced in scratch_glyph_row. Current position is W's cursor | |
3441 position. */ | |
3442 clear_glyph_row (&scratch_glyph_row); | |
3443 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, PT, PT_BYTE); | |
28361
eccb57c44da5
(direct_output_for_insert): Use DEC_TEXT_POS
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27968
diff
changeset
|
3444 DEC_TEXT_POS (pos, !NILP (current_buffer->enable_multibyte_characters)); |
25012 | 3445 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos), &scratch_glyph_row, |
3446 DEFAULT_FACE_ID); | |
3447 | |
3448 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos); | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3449 if (glyph_row->mouse_face_p) |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3450 return 0; |
25012 | 3451 |
3452 /* Give up if highlighting trailing whitespace and we have trailing | |
3453 whitespace in glyph_row. We would have to remove the trailing | |
3454 whitespace face in that case. */ | |
25304
4b75c26bd356
(direct_output_for_insert): Use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25241
diff
changeset
|
3455 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace) |
25012 | 3456 && glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) |
3457 { | |
3458 struct glyph *last; | |
3459 | |
3460 last = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; | |
3461 if (last->type == STRETCH_GLYPH | |
3462 || (last->type == CHAR_GLYPH | |
26998
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
3463 && last->u.ch == ' ')) |
25012 | 3464 return 0; |
3465 } | |
3466 | |
3467 /* Give up if there are overlay strings at pos. This would fail | |
3468 if the overlay string has newlines in it. */ | |
3469 if (STRINGP (it.string)) | |
3470 return 0; | |
3471 | |
3472 it.hpos = w->cursor.hpos; | |
3473 it.vpos = w->cursor.vpos; | |
3474 it.current_x = w->cursor.x + it.first_visible_x; | |
3475 it.current_y = w->cursor.y; | |
3476 it.end_charpos = PT; | |
3477 it.stop_charpos = min (PT, it.stop_charpos); | |
3478 | |
3479 /* More than one display element may be returned for PT - 1 if | |
3480 (i) it's a control character which is translated into `\003' or | |
3481 `^C', or (ii) it has a display table entry, or (iii) it's a | |
3482 combination of both. */ | |
3483 delta = delta_bytes = 0; | |
3484 while (get_next_display_element (&it)) | |
3485 { | |
3486 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it); | |
3487 | |
3488 /* Give up if glyph doesn't fit completely on the line. */ | |
3489 if (it.current_x >= it.last_visible_x) | |
3490 return 0; | |
3491 | |
3492 /* Give up if new glyph has different ascent or descent than | |
3493 the original row, or if it is not a character glyph. */ | |
3494 if (glyph_row->ascent != it.ascent | |
3495 || glyph_row->height != it.ascent + it.descent | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3496 || glyph_row->phys_ascent != it.phys_ascent |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3497 || glyph_row->phys_height != it.phys_ascent + it.phys_descent |
25012 | 3498 || it.what != IT_CHARACTER) |
3499 return 0; | |
3500 | |
3501 delta += 1; | |
3502 delta_bytes += it.len; | |
32468
20788c8274cd
(direct_output_for_insert): Call set_iterator_to_next
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31932
diff
changeset
|
3503 set_iterator_to_next (&it, 1); |
25012 | 3504 } |
3505 | |
3506 /* Give up if we hit the right edge of the window. We would have | |
3507 to insert truncation or continuation glyphs. */ | |
3508 added_width = it.current_x - (w->cursor.x + it.first_visible_x); | |
3509 if (glyph_row->pixel_width + added_width >= it.last_visible_x) | |
314 | 3510 return 0; |
3511 | |
25012 | 3512 /* Give up if there is a \t following in the line. */ |
3513 it2 = it; | |
3514 it2.end_charpos = ZV; | |
3515 it2.stop_charpos = min (it2.stop_charpos, ZV); | |
3516 while (get_next_display_element (&it2) | |
3517 && !ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it2)) | |
3518 { | |
3519 if (it2.c == '\t') | |
3520 return 0; | |
32468
20788c8274cd
(direct_output_for_insert): Call set_iterator_to_next
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31932
diff
changeset
|
3521 set_iterator_to_next (&it2, 1); |
25012 | 3522 } |
3523 | |
3524 /* Number of new glyphs produced. */ | |
3525 n = it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
3526 | |
3527 /* Start and end of glyphs in original row. */ | |
3528 glyphs = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos; | |
3529 end = glyph_row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA]; | |
3530 | |
3531 /* Make room for new glyphs, then insert them. */ | |
3532 xassert (end - glyphs - n >= 0); | |
25781
e5579bc77d9e
(direct_output_for_insert): Cast arguments to
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25735
diff
changeset
|
3533 safe_bcopy ((char *) glyphs, (char *) (glyphs + n), |
e5579bc77d9e
(direct_output_for_insert): Cast arguments to
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25735
diff
changeset
|
3534 (end - glyphs - n) * sizeof (*end)); |
25012 | 3535 bcopy (it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], glyphs, n * sizeof *glyphs); |
3536 glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = min (glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] + n, | |
3537 end - glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]); | |
3538 | |
3539 /* Compute new line width. */ | |
3540 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
3541 end = glyph + glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
3542 glyph_row->pixel_width = glyph_row->x; | |
3543 while (glyph < end) | |
3544 { | |
3545 glyph_row->pixel_width += glyph->pixel_width; | |
3546 ++glyph; | |
3547 } | |
3548 | |
3549 /* Increment buffer positions for glyphs following the newly | |
3550 inserted ones. */ | |
3551 for (glyph = glyphs + n; glyph < end; ++glyph) | |
26546
0f43cc91d6a5
(direct_output_for_insert): Increment glyph positions
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26499
diff
changeset
|
3552 if (glyph->charpos > 0 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)) |
25012 | 3553 glyph->charpos += delta; |
3554 | |
3555 if (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (glyph_row) > 0) | |
3556 { | |
3557 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (glyph_row) += delta; | |
3558 MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (glyph_row) += delta_bytes; | |
3559 } | |
3560 | |
3561 /* Adjust positions in lines following the one we are in. */ | |
28708
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
3562 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix, |
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
3563 w->cursor.vpos + 1, |
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
3564 w->current_matrix->nrows, |
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
3565 delta, delta_bytes); |
25012 | 3566 |
3567 glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p | |
3568 |= it.glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p; | |
3569 | |
26591
f7c7ef351f04
(direct_output_for_insert): Set glyph row's
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26546
diff
changeset
|
3570 glyph_row->displays_text_p = 1; |
f7c7ef351f04
(direct_output_for_insert): Set glyph row's
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26546
diff
changeset
|
3571 w->window_end_vpos = make_number (max (w->cursor.vpos, |
f7c7ef351f04
(direct_output_for_insert): Set glyph row's
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26546
diff
changeset
|
3572 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos))); |
f7c7ef351f04
(direct_output_for_insert): Set glyph row's
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26546
diff
changeset
|
3573 |
25304
4b75c26bd356
(direct_output_for_insert): Use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25241
diff
changeset
|
3574 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)) |
25012 | 3575 highlight_trailing_whitespace (it.f, glyph_row); |
3576 | |
3577 /* Write glyphs. If at end of row, we can simply call write_glyphs. | |
3578 In the middle, we have to insert glyphs. Note that this is now | |
3579 implemented for X frames. The implementation uses updated_window | |
3580 and updated_row. */ | |
3581 updated_row = glyph_row; | |
3582 update_begin (f); | |
3583 if (rif) | |
3584 { | |
3585 rif->update_window_begin_hook (w); | |
3586 | |
36115
c0fac212cfcc
(direct_output_for_insert): Recognize more cases where
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36097
diff
changeset
|
3587 if (glyphs == end - n |
c0fac212cfcc
(direct_output_for_insert): Recognize more cases where
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36097
diff
changeset
|
3588 /* In front of a space added by append_space. */ |
c0fac212cfcc
(direct_output_for_insert): Recognize more cases where
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36097
diff
changeset
|
3589 || (glyphs == end - n - 1 |
c0fac212cfcc
(direct_output_for_insert): Recognize more cases where
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36097
diff
changeset
|
3590 && (end - n)->charpos <= 0)) |
25012 | 3591 rif->write_glyphs (glyphs, n); |
3592 else | |
3593 rif->insert_glyphs (glyphs, n); | |
3594 } | |
3595 else | |
3596 { | |
3597 if (glyphs == end - n) | |
3598 write_glyphs (glyphs, n); | |
3599 else | |
3600 insert_glyphs (glyphs, n); | |
3601 } | |
3602 | |
3603 w->cursor.hpos += n; | |
3604 w->cursor.x = it.current_x - it.first_visible_x; | |
3605 xassert (w->cursor.hpos >= 0 | |
3606 && w->cursor.hpos < w->desired_matrix->matrix_w); | |
3607 | |
3608 /* How to set the cursor differs depending on whether we are | |
3609 using a frame matrix or a window matrix. Note that when | |
3610 a frame matrix is used, cursor_to expects frame coordinates, | |
3611 and the X and Y parameters are not used. */ | |
3612 if (window_redisplay_p) | |
3613 rif->cursor_to (w->cursor.vpos, w->cursor.hpos, | |
3614 w->cursor.y, w->cursor.x); | |
3615 else | |
3616 { | |
3617 int x, y; | |
3618 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS (w, w->cursor.hpos) | |
3619 + (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_width) | |
3620 ? XFASTINT (w->left_margin_width) | |
3621 : 0)); | |
3622 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS (w, w->cursor.vpos); | |
3623 cursor_to (y, x); | |
3624 } | |
3625 | |
3626 if (rif) | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3627 rif->update_window_end_hook (w, 1, 0); |
25012 | 3628 update_end (f); |
3629 updated_row = NULL; | |
3630 fflush (stdout); | |
3631 | |
3632 TRACE ((stderr, "direct output for insert\n")); | |
3633 | |
25372
acf281b41a38
(direct_output_for_insert): Set beg_unchanged
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25345
diff
changeset
|
3634 UNCHANGED_MODIFIED = MODIFF; |
acf281b41a38
(direct_output_for_insert): Set beg_unchanged
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25345
diff
changeset
|
3635 BEG_UNCHANGED = GPT - BEG; |
16039
855c8d8ba0f0
Change all references from point to PT.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
3636 XSETFASTINT (w->last_point, PT); |
25012 | 3637 w->last_cursor = w->cursor; |
9303
3115ae493c30
(direct_output_for_insert, direct_output_forward_char, change_frame_size,
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
9264
diff
changeset
|
3638 XSETFASTINT (w->last_modified, MODIFF); |
16195
e15e4bdcb8cc
(direct_output_for_insert): Set last_overlay_modified field in window.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16051
diff
changeset
|
3639 XSETFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified, OVERLAY_MODIFF); |
314 | 3640 |
25012 | 3641 redisplay_performed_directly_p = 1; |
314 | 3642 return 1; |
3643 } | |
3644 | |
25012 | 3645 |
3646 /* Perform a direct display update for moving PT by N positions | |
3647 left or right. N < 0 means a movement backwards. This function | |
3648 is currently only called for N == 1 or N == -1. */ | |
3649 | |
314 | 3650 int |
3651 direct_output_forward_char (n) | |
3652 int n; | |
3653 { | |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
3654 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME (); |
25012 | 3655 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window); |
3656 struct glyph_row *row; | |
3657 | |
26851
2513566d55fd
(direct_output_forward_char): Check point moving into
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26729
diff
changeset
|
3658 /* Give up if point moved out of or into a composition. */ |
28507
b6f06a755c7d
make_number/XINT/XUINT conversions; EQ/== fixes; ==Qnil -> NILP
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
28361
diff
changeset
|
3659 if (check_point_in_composition (current_buffer, XINT (w->last_point), |
26851
2513566d55fd
(direct_output_forward_char): Check point moving into
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26729
diff
changeset
|
3660 current_buffer, PT)) |
2513566d55fd
(direct_output_forward_char): Check point moving into
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26729
diff
changeset
|
3661 return 0; |
2513566d55fd
(direct_output_forward_char): Check point moving into
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26729
diff
changeset
|
3662 |
25012 | 3663 /* Give up if face attributes have been changed. */ |
3664 if (face_change_count) | |
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
3665 return 0; |
25012 | 3666 |
3667 /* Give up if current matrix is not up to date or we are | |
3668 displaying a message. */ | |
3669 if (!display_completed || cursor_in_echo_area) | |
3670 return 0; | |
3671 | |
3672 /* Give up if the buffer's direction is reversed. */ | |
3673 if (!NILP (XBUFFER (w->buffer)->direction_reversed)) | |
314 | 3674 return 0; |
11096
cac0367b1794
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use direct output at an overlay boundary.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
10770
diff
changeset
|
3675 |
2794
9163e4e4752c
(direct_output_forward_char): Just give up
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
2778
diff
changeset
|
3676 /* Can't use direct output if highlighting a region. */ |
9163e4e4752c
(direct_output_forward_char): Just give up
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
2778
diff
changeset
|
3677 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode) && !NILP (current_buffer->mark_active)) |
9163e4e4752c
(direct_output_forward_char): Just give up
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
2778
diff
changeset
|
3678 return 0; |
9163e4e4752c
(direct_output_forward_char): Just give up
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
2778
diff
changeset
|
3679 |
25304
4b75c26bd356
(direct_output_for_insert): Use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25241
diff
changeset
|
3680 /* Can't use direct output if highlighting trailing whitespace. */ |
4b75c26bd356
(direct_output_for_insert): Use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25241
diff
changeset
|
3681 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)) |
4b75c26bd356
(direct_output_for_insert): Use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25241
diff
changeset
|
3682 return 0; |
4b75c26bd356
(direct_output_for_insert): Use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25241
diff
changeset
|
3683 |
25735
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3684 /* Give up if we are showing a message or just cleared the message |
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3685 because we might need to resize the echo area window. */ |
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3686 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) || !NILP (echo_area_buffer[1])) |
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3687 return 0; |
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3688 |
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
3689 /* Give up if currently displaying a message instead of the |
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
3690 minibuffer contents. */ |
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
3691 if (XWINDOW (minibuf_window) == w |
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
3692 && EQ (minibuf_window, echo_area_window)) |
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
3693 return 0; |
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
3694 |
25735
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3695 /* Give up if we don't know where the cursor is. */ |
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3696 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0) |
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3697 return 0; |
fcb92c26acf2
(direct_output_forward_char): Don't use this method
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25725
diff
changeset
|
3698 |
25012 | 3699 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos); |
3700 | |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
3701 /* Give up if PT is outside of the last known cursor row. */ |
25012 | 3702 if (PT <= MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) |
3703 || PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row)) | |
6069
07045ca8ff19
(direct_output_forward_char): Use Fget_char_property to test for invisibility.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
6068
diff
changeset
|
3704 return 0; |
4384
98605d0ea3cf
(direct_output_for_insert): Fail if character
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
4290
diff
changeset
|
3705 |
25012 | 3706 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0); |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
3707 |
25012 | 3708 w->last_cursor = w->cursor; |
16039
855c8d8ba0f0
Change all references from point to PT.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15896
diff
changeset
|
3709 XSETFASTINT (w->last_point, PT); |
25012 | 3710 |
3711 xassert (w->cursor.hpos >= 0 | |
3712 && w->cursor.hpos < w->desired_matrix->matrix_w); | |
3713 | |
3714 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) | |
3715 rif->cursor_to (w->cursor.vpos, w->cursor.hpos, | |
3716 w->cursor.y, w->cursor.x); | |
3717 else | |
3718 { | |
3719 int x, y; | |
3720 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS (w, w->cursor.hpos) | |
3721 + (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_width) | |
3722 ? XFASTINT (w->left_margin_width) | |
3723 : 0)); | |
3724 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS (w, w->cursor.vpos); | |
3725 cursor_to (y, x); | |
3726 } | |
3727 | |
314 | 3728 fflush (stdout); |
25012 | 3729 redisplay_performed_directly_p = 1; |
314 | 3730 return 1; |
3731 } | |
25012 | 3732 |
3733 | |
314 | 3734 |
25012 | 3735 /*********************************************************************** |
3736 Frame Update | |
3737 ***********************************************************************/ | |
3738 | |
3739 /* Update frame F based on the data in desired matrices. | |
3740 | |
3741 If FORCE_P is non-zero, don't let redisplay be stopped by detecting | |
3742 pending input. If INHIBIT_HAIRY_ID_P is non-zero, don't try | |
3743 scrolling. | |
3744 | |
3745 Value is non-zero if redisplay was stopped due to pending input. */ | |
314 | 3746 |
3747 int | |
25012 | 3748 update_frame (f, force_p, inhibit_hairy_id_p) |
3749 struct frame *f; | |
3750 int force_p; | |
3751 int inhibit_hairy_id_p; | |
3752 { | |
3753 /* 1 means display has been paused because of pending input. */ | |
3754 int paused_p; | |
3755 struct window *root_window = XWINDOW (f->root_window); | |
3756 | |
3757 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) | |
3758 { | |
3759 /* We are working on window matrix basis. All windows whose | |
3760 flag must_be_updated_p is set have to be updated. */ | |
3761 | |
3762 /* Record that we are not working on frame matrices. */ | |
3763 set_frame_matrix_frame (NULL); | |
3764 | |
3765 /* Update all windows in the window tree of F, maybe stopping | |
3766 when pending input is detected. */ | |
3767 update_begin (f); | |
3768 | |
3769 /* Update the menu bar on X frames that don't have toolkit | |
3770 support. */ | |
3771 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
3772 update_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), 1); | |
3773 | |
3774 /* Update the tool-bar window, if present. */ | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3775 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
25012 | 3776 { |
3777 Lisp_Object tem; | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3778 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window); |
25012 | 3779 |
3780 /* Update tool-bar window. */ | |
3781 if (w->must_be_updated_p) | |
3782 { | |
3783 update_window (w, 1); | |
3784 w->must_be_updated_p = 0; | |
3785 | |
3786 /* Swap tool-bar strings. We swap because we want to | |
3787 reuse strings. */ | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3788 tem = f->current_tool_bar_string; |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3789 f->current_tool_bar_string = f->desired_tool_bar_string; |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3790 f->desired_tool_bar_string = tem; |
25012 | 3791 } |
3792 } | |
3793 | |
3794 | |
3795 /* Update windows. */ | |
3796 paused_p = update_window_tree (root_window, force_p); | |
3797 update_end (f); | |
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3798 |
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3799 #if 0 /* This flush is a performance bottleneck under X, |
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3800 and it doesn't seem to be necessary anyway. */ |
25012 | 3801 rif->flush_display (f); |
3802 #endif | |
3803 } | |
3804 else | |
3805 { | |
3806 /* We are working on frame matrix basis. Set the frame on whose | |
3807 frame matrix we operate. */ | |
3808 set_frame_matrix_frame (f); | |
3809 | |
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3810 /* Build F's desired matrix from window matrices. */ |
25012 | 3811 build_frame_matrix (f); |
3812 | |
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3813 /* Update the display */ |
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3814 update_begin (f); |
25012 | 3815 paused_p = update_frame_1 (f, force_p, inhibit_hairy_id_p); |
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3816 update_end (f); |
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3817 |
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3818 if (termscript) |
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3819 fflush (termscript); |
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3820 fflush (stdout); |
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3821 |
25012 | 3822 /* Check window matrices for lost pointers. */ |
34893
779bd3fa820e
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34866
diff
changeset
|
3823 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
3824 check_window_matrix_pointers (root_window); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
3825 add_frame_display_history (f, paused_p); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
3826 #endif |
25012 | 3827 } |
3828 | |
3829 /* Reset flags indicating that a window should be updated. */ | |
3830 set_window_update_flags (root_window, 0); | |
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3831 |
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3832 display_completed = !paused_p; |
25012 | 3833 return paused_p; |
3834 } | |
3835 | |
3836 | |
3837 | |
3838 /************************************************************************ | |
3839 Window-based updates | |
3840 ************************************************************************/ | |
3841 | |
3842 /* Perform updates in window tree rooted at W. FORCE_P non-zero means | |
3843 don't stop updating when input is pending. */ | |
3844 | |
3845 static int | |
3846 update_window_tree (w, force_p) | |
3847 struct window *w; | |
3848 int force_p; | |
3849 { | |
3850 int paused_p = 0; | |
3851 | |
3852 while (w && !paused_p) | |
3853 { | |
3854 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
3855 paused_p |= update_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), force_p); | |
3856 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
3857 paused_p |= update_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), force_p); | |
3858 else if (w->must_be_updated_p) | |
3859 paused_p |= update_window (w, force_p); | |
3860 | |
3861 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
3862 } | |
3863 | |
3864 return paused_p; | |
3865 } | |
3866 | |
3867 | |
3868 /* Update window W if its flag must_be_updated_p is non-zero. If | |
3869 FORCE_P is non-zero, don't stop updating if input is pending. */ | |
3870 | |
3871 void | |
3872 update_single_window (w, force_p) | |
3873 struct window *w; | |
3874 int force_p; | |
3875 { | |
3876 if (w->must_be_updated_p) | |
3877 { | |
3878 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)); | |
3879 | |
3880 /* Record that this is not a frame-based redisplay. */ | |
3881 set_frame_matrix_frame (NULL); | |
3882 | |
3883 /* Update W. */ | |
3884 update_begin (f); | |
3885 update_window (w, force_p); | |
3886 update_end (f); | |
3887 | |
3888 /* Reset flag in W. */ | |
3889 w->must_be_updated_p = 0; | |
3890 } | |
3891 } | |
3892 | |
3893 | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3894 /* Redraw lines from the current matrix of window W that are |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3895 overlapped by other rows. YB is bottom-most y-position in W. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3896 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3897 static void |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3898 redraw_overlapped_rows (w, yb) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3899 struct window *w; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3900 int yb; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3901 { |
30165
d7ec5b3caccc
(redraw_overlapped_rows): Add missing local.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30161
diff
changeset
|
3902 int i; |
d7ec5b3caccc
(redraw_overlapped_rows): Add missing local.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30161
diff
changeset
|
3903 |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3904 /* If rows overlapping others have been changed, the rows being |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3905 overlapped have to be redrawn. This won't draw lines that have |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3906 already been drawn in update_window_line because overlapped_p in |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3907 desired rows is 0, so after row assignment overlapped_p in |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3908 current rows is 0. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3909 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3910 { |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3911 struct glyph_row *row = w->current_matrix->rows + i; |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3912 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3913 if (!row->enabled_p) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3914 break; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3915 else if (row->mode_line_p) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3916 continue; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3917 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3918 if (row->overlapped_p) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3919 { |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3920 enum glyph_row_area area; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3921 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3922 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3923 { |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3924 updated_row = row; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3925 updated_area = area; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3926 rif->cursor_to (i, 0, row->y, area == TEXT_AREA ? row->x : 0); |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3927 if (row->used[area]) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3928 rif->write_glyphs (row->glyphs[area], row->used[area]); |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3929 rif->clear_end_of_line (-1); |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3930 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3931 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3932 row->overlapped_p = 0; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3933 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3934 |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3935 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb) |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3936 break; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3937 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3938 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3939 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3940 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3941 /* Redraw lines from the current matrix of window W that overlap |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3942 others. YB is bottom-most y-position in W. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3943 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3944 static void |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3945 redraw_overlapping_rows (w, yb) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3946 struct window *w; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3947 int yb; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3948 { |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3949 int i, bottom_y; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3950 struct glyph_row *row; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3951 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3952 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3953 { |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3954 row = w->current_matrix->rows + i; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3955 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3956 if (!row->enabled_p) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3957 break; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3958 else if (row->mode_line_p) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3959 continue; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3960 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3961 bottom_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row); |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3962 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3963 if (row->overlapping_p && i > 0 && bottom_y < yb) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3964 { |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3965 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3966 rif->fix_overlapping_area (w, row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA); |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3967 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3968 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA]) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3969 rif->fix_overlapping_area (w, row, TEXT_AREA); |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3970 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3971 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3972 rif->fix_overlapping_area (w, row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA); |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3973 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3974 /* Record in neighbor rows that ROW overwrites part of their |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3975 display. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3976 if (row->phys_ascent > row->ascent && i > 0) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3977 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i - 1)->overlapped_p = 1; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3978 if ((row->phys_height - row->phys_ascent |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3979 > row->height - row->ascent) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3980 && bottom_y < yb) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3981 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i + 1)->overlapped_p = 1; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3982 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3983 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3984 if (bottom_y >= yb) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3985 break; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3986 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3987 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3988 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3989 |
34929
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3990 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3991 |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3992 /* Check that no row in the current matrix of window W is enabled |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3993 which is below what's displayed in the window. */ |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3994 |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3995 void |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3996 check_current_matrix_flags (w) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3997 struct window *w; |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3998 { |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3999 int last_seen_p = 0; |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4000 int i, yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4001 |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4002 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows - 1; ++i) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4003 { |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4004 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i); |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4005 if (!last_seen_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4006 last_seen_p = 1; |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4007 else if (last_seen_p && row->enabled_p) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4008 abort (); |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4009 } |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4010 } |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4011 |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4012 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */ |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4013 |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4014 |
25012 | 4015 /* Update display of window W. FORCE_P non-zero means that we should |
4016 not stop when detecting pending input. */ | |
4017 | |
4018 static int | |
4019 update_window (w, force_p) | |
4020 struct window *w; | |
4021 int force_p; | |
4022 { | |
4023 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix; | |
4024 int paused_p; | |
4025 int preempt_count = baud_rate / 2400 + 1; | |
4026 extern int input_pending; | |
34517
7c8d2cec3d08
(update_window): If do_mouse_tracking is non-nil,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34279
diff
changeset
|
4027 extern Lisp_Object do_mouse_tracking; |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4028 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4029 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)); |
25012 | 4030 extern struct frame *updating_frame; |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4031 #endif |
25012 | 4032 |
4033 /* Check that W's frame doesn't have glyph matrices. */ | |
4034 xassert (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); | |
4035 xassert (updating_frame != NULL); | |
4036 | |
4037 /* Check pending input the first time so that we can quickly return. */ | |
4038 if (redisplay_dont_pause) | |
4039 force_p = 1; | |
4040 else | |
4041 detect_input_pending (); | |
4042 | |
4043 /* If forced to complete the update, or if no input is pending, do | |
4044 the update. */ | |
34517
7c8d2cec3d08
(update_window): If do_mouse_tracking is non-nil,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34279
diff
changeset
|
4045 if (force_p || !input_pending || !NILP (do_mouse_tracking)) |
25012 | 4046 { |
4047 struct glyph_row *row, *end; | |
4048 struct glyph_row *mode_line_row; | |
25546 | 4049 struct glyph_row *header_line_row = NULL; |
34622
877ed6cab304
(update_window): Detect pending input every nth line
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34517
diff
changeset
|
4050 int yb, changed_p = 0, mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0, n_updated; |
25012 | 4051 |
4052 rif->update_window_begin_hook (w); | |
4053 yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); | |
4054 | |
4055 /* If window has a top line, update it before everything else. | |
4056 Adjust y-positions of other rows by the top line height. */ | |
4057 row = desired_matrix->rows; | |
4058 end = row + desired_matrix->nrows - 1; | |
4059 if (row->mode_line_p) | |
25546 | 4060 header_line_row = row++; |
25012 | 4061 |
4062 /* Update the mode line, if necessary. */ | |
4063 mode_line_row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (desired_matrix); | |
4064 if (mode_line_row->mode_line_p && mode_line_row->enabled_p) | |
4065 { | |
4066 mode_line_row->y = yb; | |
4067 update_window_line (w, MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (mode_line_row, | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4068 desired_matrix), |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4069 &mouse_face_overwritten_p); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4070 changed_p = 1; |
25012 | 4071 } |
4072 | |
4073 /* Find first enabled row. Optimizations in redisplay_internal | |
4074 may lead to an update with only one row enabled. There may | |
4075 be also completely empty matrices. */ | |
4076 while (row < end && !row->enabled_p) | |
4077 ++row; | |
4078 | |
31825
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4079 /* Try reusing part of the display by copying. */ |
25012 | 4080 if (row < end && !desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p) |
4081 { | |
25546 | 4082 int rc = scrolling_window (w, header_line_row != NULL); |
25012 | 4083 if (rc < 0) |
4084 { | |
4085 /* All rows were found to be equal. */ | |
4086 paused_p = 0; | |
4087 goto set_cursor; | |
4088 } | |
4089 else if (rc > 0) | |
4090 force_p = 1; | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4091 changed_p = 1; |
25012 | 4092 } |
4093 | |
4094 /* Update the top mode line after scrolling because a new top | |
4095 line would otherwise overwrite lines at the top of the window | |
4096 that can be scrolled. */ | |
25546 | 4097 if (header_line_row && header_line_row->enabled_p) |
25012 | 4098 { |
25546 | 4099 header_line_row->y = 0; |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4100 update_window_line (w, 0, &mouse_face_overwritten_p); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4101 changed_p = 1; |
25012 | 4102 } |
4103 | |
4104 /* Update the rest of the lines. */ | |
34622
877ed6cab304
(update_window): Detect pending input every nth line
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34517
diff
changeset
|
4105 for (n_updated = 0; row < end && (force_p || !input_pending); ++row) |
31653
2554afbeb88d
(update_window): Make sure to make desired rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31295
diff
changeset
|
4106 if (row->enabled_p) |
25012 | 4107 { |
4108 int vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, desired_matrix); | |
4109 int i; | |
4110 | |
4111 /* We'll Have to play a little bit with when to | |
4112 detect_input_pending. If it's done too often, | |
4113 scrolling large windows with repeated scroll-up | |
4114 commands will too quickly pause redisplay. */ | |
34622
877ed6cab304
(update_window): Detect pending input every nth line
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34517
diff
changeset
|
4115 if (!force_p && ++n_updated % preempt_count == 0) |
25012 | 4116 detect_input_pending (); |
4117 | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4118 changed_p |= update_window_line (w, vpos, |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4119 &mouse_face_overwritten_p); |
25012 | 4120 |
4121 /* Mark all rows below the last visible one in the current | |
4122 matrix as invalid. This is necessary because of | |
4123 variable line heights. Consider the case of three | |
4124 successive redisplays, where the first displays 5 | |
4125 lines, the second 3 lines, and the third 5 lines again. | |
4126 If the second redisplay wouldn't mark rows in the | |
4127 current matrix invalid, the third redisplay might be | |
4128 tempted to optimize redisplay based on lines displayed | |
4129 in the first redisplay. */ | |
4130 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb) | |
4131 for (i = vpos + 1; i < w->current_matrix->nrows - 1; ++i) | |
4132 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i)->enabled_p = 0; | |
4133 } | |
4134 | |
4135 /* Was display preempted? */ | |
4136 paused_p = row < end; | |
4137 | |
4138 set_cursor: | |
4139 | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4140 /* Fix the appearance of overlapping(overlapped rows. */ |
25012 | 4141 if (!paused_p && !w->pseudo_window_p) |
4142 { | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4143 if (changed_p && rif->fix_overlapping_area) |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4144 { |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4145 redraw_overlapped_rows (w, yb); |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4146 redraw_overlapping_rows (w, yb); |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4147 } |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4148 |
25012 | 4149 /* Make cursor visible at cursor position of W. */ |
4150 set_window_cursor_after_update (w); | |
4151 | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4152 #if 0 /* Check that current matrix invariants are satisfied. This is |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4153 for debugging only. See the comment of check_matrix_invariants. */ |
25012 | 4154 IF_DEBUG (check_matrix_invariants (w)); |
4155 #endif | |
4156 } | |
4157 | |
4158 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
4159 /* Remember the redisplay method used to display the matrix. */ | |
4160 strcpy (w->current_matrix->method, w->desired_matrix->method); | |
4161 #endif | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4162 |
25012 | 4163 /* End of update of window W. */ |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4164 rif->update_window_end_hook (w, 1, mouse_face_overwritten_p); |
25012 | 4165 } |
4166 else | |
4167 paused_p = 1; | |
4168 | |
34893
779bd3fa820e
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34866
diff
changeset
|
4169 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
34944
4fc804373f2a
(update_window): Don't check_current_matrix_flags.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34929
diff
changeset
|
4170 /* check_current_matrix_flags (w); */ |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
4171 add_window_display_history (w, w->current_matrix->method, paused_p); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
4172 #endif |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
4173 |
25012 | 4174 clear_glyph_matrix (desired_matrix); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4175 |
25012 | 4176 return paused_p; |
4177 } | |
4178 | |
4179 | |
4180 /* Update the display of area AREA in window W, row number VPOS. | |
4181 AREA can be either LEFT_MARGIN_AREA or RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA. */ | |
4182 | |
4183 static void | |
4184 update_marginal_area (w, area, vpos) | |
4185 struct window *w; | |
4186 int area, vpos; | |
4187 { | |
4188 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, vpos); | |
4189 | |
4190 /* Let functions in xterm.c know what area subsequent X positions | |
4191 will be relative to. */ | |
4192 updated_area = area; | |
4193 | |
4194 /* Set cursor to start of glyphs, write them, and clear to the end | |
4195 of the area. I don't think that something more sophisticated is | |
4196 necessary here, since marginal areas will not be the default. */ | |
4197 rif->cursor_to (vpos, 0, desired_row->y, 0); | |
4198 if (desired_row->used[area]) | |
4199 rif->write_glyphs (desired_row->glyphs[area], desired_row->used[area]); | |
4200 rif->clear_end_of_line (-1); | |
4201 } | |
4202 | |
4203 | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4204 /* Update the display of the text area of row VPOS in window W. |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4205 Value is non-zero if display has changed. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4206 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4207 static int |
25012 | 4208 update_text_area (w, vpos) |
4209 struct window *w; | |
4210 int vpos; | |
314 | 4211 { |
25012 | 4212 struct glyph_row *current_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos); |
4213 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, vpos); | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4214 int changed_p = 0; |
25012 | 4215 |
4216 /* Let functions in xterm.c know what area subsequent X positions | |
4217 will be relative to. */ | |
4218 updated_area = TEXT_AREA; | |
4219 | |
4220 /* If rows are at different X or Y, or rows have different height, | |
4221 or the current row is marked invalid, write the entire line. */ | |
4222 if (!current_row->enabled_p | |
4223 || desired_row->y != current_row->y | |
4224 || desired_row->ascent != current_row->ascent | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4225 || desired_row->phys_ascent != current_row->phys_ascent |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4226 || desired_row->phys_height != current_row->phys_height |
25012 | 4227 || desired_row->visible_height != current_row->visible_height |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4228 || current_row->overlapped_p |
30307
faf4e303bab7
(update_text_area): Write the whole row if it
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30165
diff
changeset
|
4229 || current_row->mouse_face_p |
25012 | 4230 || current_row->x != desired_row->x) |
4231 { | |
4232 rif->cursor_to (vpos, 0, desired_row->y, desired_row->x); | |
4233 | |
4234 if (desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
4235 rif->write_glyphs (desired_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], | |
4236 desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]); | |
4237 | |
4238 /* Clear to end of window. */ | |
4239 rif->clear_end_of_line (-1); | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4240 changed_p = 1; |
25012 | 4241 } |
4242 else | |
4243 { | |
4244 int stop, i, x; | |
4245 struct glyph *current_glyph = current_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
4246 struct glyph *desired_glyph = desired_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4247 int overlapping_glyphs_p = current_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p; |
35268
d93bf580d166
(update_text_area): Put code which decrements the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35006
diff
changeset
|
4248 int desired_stop_pos = desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; |
d93bf580d166
(update_text_area): Put code which decrements the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35006
diff
changeset
|
4249 |
25012 | 4250 /* If the desired row extends its face to the text area end, |
4251 make sure we write at least one glyph, so that the face | |
4252 extension actually takes place. */ | |
35269 | 4253 if (MATRIX_ROW_EXTENDS_FACE_P (desired_row)) |
35268
d93bf580d166
(update_text_area): Put code which decrements the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35006
diff
changeset
|
4254 --desired_stop_pos; |
25012 | 4255 |
4256 stop = min (current_row->used[TEXT_AREA], desired_stop_pos); | |
4257 i = 0; | |
4258 x = desired_row->x; | |
36097
1dfaaf6d6166
(update_text_area): Undo change of 2001-01-12.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35924
diff
changeset
|
4259 |
1dfaaf6d6166
(update_text_area): Undo change of 2001-01-12.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35924
diff
changeset
|
4260 /* Loop over glyphs that current and desired row may have |
1dfaaf6d6166
(update_text_area): Undo change of 2001-01-12.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35924
diff
changeset
|
4261 in common. */ |
25012 | 4262 while (i < stop) |
4263 { | |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4264 int can_skip_p = 1; |
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4265 |
25012 | 4266 /* Skip over glyphs that both rows have in common. These |
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4267 don't have to be written. We can't skip if the last |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4268 current glyph overlaps the glyph to its right. For |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4269 example, consider a current row of `if ' with the `f' in |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4270 Courier bold so that it overlaps the ` ' to its right. |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4271 If the desired row is ` ', we would skip over the space |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4272 after the `if' and there would remain a pixel from the |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4273 `f' on the screen. */ |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4274 if (overlapping_glyphs_p && i > 0) |
25012 | 4275 { |
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4276 struct glyph *glyph = ¤t_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i - 1]; |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4277 int left, right; |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4278 |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4279 rif->get_glyph_overhangs (glyph, XFRAME (w->frame), |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4280 &left, &right); |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4281 can_skip_p = right == 0; |
25012 | 4282 } |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4283 |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4284 if (can_skip_p) |
25012 | 4285 { |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4286 while (i < stop |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4287 && GLYPH_EQUAL_P (desired_glyph, current_glyph)) |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4288 { |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4289 x += desired_glyph->pixel_width; |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4290 ++desired_glyph, ++current_glyph, ++i; |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4291 } |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4292 |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4293 /* Consider the case that the current row contains "xxx |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4294 ppp ggg" in italic Courier font, and the desired row |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4295 is "xxx ggg". The character `p' has lbearing, `g' |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4296 has not. The loop above will stop in front of the |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4297 first `p' in the current row. If we would start |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4298 writing glyphs there, we wouldn't erase the lbearing |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4299 of the `p'. The rest of the lbearing problem is then |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4300 taken care of by x_draw_glyphs. */ |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4301 if (overlapping_glyphs_p |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4302 && i > 0 |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4303 && i < current_row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4304 && (current_row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4305 != desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA])) |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4306 { |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4307 int left, right; |
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4308 |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4309 rif->get_glyph_overhangs (current_glyph, XFRAME (w->frame), |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4310 &left, &right); |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4311 while (left > 0 && i > 0) |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4312 { |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4313 --i, --desired_glyph, --current_glyph; |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4314 x -= desired_glyph->pixel_width; |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4315 left -= desired_glyph->pixel_width; |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4316 } |
25012 | 4317 } |
4318 } | |
4319 | |
4320 /* Try to avoid writing the entire rest of the desired row | |
4321 by looking for a resync point. This mainly prevents | |
4322 mode line flickering in the case the mode line is in | |
4323 fixed-pitch font, which it usually will be. */ | |
4324 if (i < desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
4325 { | |
4326 int start_x = x, start_hpos = i; | |
4327 struct glyph *start = desired_glyph; | |
4328 int current_x = x; | |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4329 int skip_first_p = !can_skip_p; |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4330 |
25012 | 4331 /* Find the next glyph that's equal again. */ |
4332 while (i < stop | |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4333 && (skip_first_p |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4334 || !GLYPH_EQUAL_P (desired_glyph, current_glyph)) |
25012 | 4335 && x == current_x) |
4336 { | |
4337 x += desired_glyph->pixel_width; | |
4338 current_x += current_glyph->pixel_width; | |
4339 ++desired_glyph, ++current_glyph, ++i; | |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4340 skip_first_p = 0; |
25012 | 4341 } |
4342 | |
4343 if (i == start_hpos || x != current_x) | |
4344 { | |
4345 i = start_hpos; | |
4346 x = start_x; | |
4347 desired_glyph = start; | |
4348 break; | |
4349 } | |
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4350 |
25012 | 4351 rif->cursor_to (vpos, start_hpos, desired_row->y, start_x); |
4352 rif->write_glyphs (start, i - start_hpos); | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4353 changed_p = 1; |
25012 | 4354 } |
4355 } | |
4356 | |
4357 /* Write the rest. */ | |
4358 if (i < desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
4359 { | |
4360 rif->cursor_to (vpos, i, desired_row->y, x); | |
4361 rif->write_glyphs (desired_glyph, desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - i); | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4362 changed_p = 1; |
25012 | 4363 } |
4364 | |
4365 /* Maybe clear to end of line. */ | |
4366 if (MATRIX_ROW_EXTENDS_FACE_P (desired_row)) | |
4367 { | |
4368 /* If new row extends to the end of the text area, nothing | |
4369 has to be cleared, if and only if we did a write_glyphs | |
4370 above. This is made sure by setting desired_stop_pos | |
4371 appropriately above. */ | |
4372 xassert (i < desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]); | |
4373 } | |
4374 else if (MATRIX_ROW_EXTENDS_FACE_P (current_row)) | |
4375 { | |
4376 /* If old row extends to the end of the text area, clear. */ | |
4377 if (i >= desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
4378 rif->cursor_to (vpos, i, desired_row->y, | |
4379 desired_row->x + desired_row->pixel_width); | |
4380 rif->clear_end_of_line (-1); | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4381 changed_p = 1; |
25012 | 4382 } |
4383 else if (desired_row->pixel_width < current_row->pixel_width) | |
4384 { | |
4385 /* Otherwise clear to the end of the old row. Everything | |
4386 after that position should be clear already. */ | |
4387 int x; | |
4388 | |
4389 if (i >= desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
4390 rif->cursor_to (vpos, i, desired_row->y, | |
4391 desired_row->x + desired_row->pixel_width); | |
4392 | |
4393 /* If cursor is displayed at the end of the line, make sure | |
4394 it's cleared. Nowadays we don't have a phys_cursor_glyph | |
4395 with which to erase the cursor (because this method | |
4396 doesn't work with lbearing/rbearing), so we must do it | |
4397 this way. */ | |
4398 if (vpos == w->phys_cursor.vpos | |
4399 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
4400 { | |
4401 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0; | |
4402 x = -1; | |
4403 } | |
4404 else | |
4405 x = current_row->x + current_row->pixel_width; | |
4406 rif->clear_end_of_line (x); | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4407 changed_p = 1; |
25012 | 4408 } |
4409 } | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4410 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4411 return changed_p; |
25012 | 4412 } |
4413 | |
4414 | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4415 /* Update row VPOS in window W. Value is non-zero if display has been |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4416 changed. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4417 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4418 static int |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4419 update_window_line (w, vpos, mouse_face_overwritten_p) |
25012 | 4420 struct window *w; |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4421 int vpos, *mouse_face_overwritten_p; |
25012 | 4422 { |
4423 struct glyph_row *current_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos); | |
4424 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, vpos); | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4425 int changed_p = 0; |
25012 | 4426 |
4427 /* Set the row being updated. This is important to let xterm.c | |
4428 know what line height values are in effect. */ | |
4429 updated_row = desired_row; | |
4430 | |
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4431 /* A row can be completely invisible in case a desired matrix was |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4432 built with a vscroll and then make_cursor_line_fully_visible shifts |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4433 the matrix. Make sure to make such rows current anyway, since |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4434 we need the correct y-position, for example, in the current matrix. */ |
31726
59b455472b56
(update_window_line): Make sure to always draw
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31690
diff
changeset
|
4435 if (desired_row->mode_line_p |
59b455472b56
(update_window_line): Make sure to always draw
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31690
diff
changeset
|
4436 || desired_row->visible_height > 0) |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4437 { |
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4438 xassert (desired_row->enabled_p); |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4439 |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4440 /* Update display of the left margin area, if there is one. */ |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4441 if (!desired_row->full_width_p |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4442 && !NILP (w->left_margin_width)) |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4443 { |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4444 changed_p = 1; |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4445 update_marginal_area (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA, vpos); |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4446 } |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4447 |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4448 /* Update the display of the text area. */ |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4449 if (update_text_area (w, vpos)) |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4450 { |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4451 changed_p = 1; |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4452 if (current_row->mouse_face_p) |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4453 *mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1; |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4454 } |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4455 |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4456 /* Update display of the right margin area, if there is one. */ |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4457 if (!desired_row->full_width_p |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4458 && !NILP (w->right_margin_width)) |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4459 { |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4460 changed_p = 1; |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4461 update_marginal_area (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA, vpos); |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4462 } |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4463 |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4464 /* Draw truncation marks etc. */ |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4465 if (!current_row->enabled_p |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4466 || desired_row->y != current_row->y |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4467 || desired_row->visible_height != current_row->visible_height |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4468 || desired_row->overlay_arrow_p != current_row->overlay_arrow_p |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4469 || desired_row->truncated_on_left_p != current_row->truncated_on_left_p |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4470 || desired_row->truncated_on_right_p != current_row->truncated_on_right_p |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4471 || desired_row->continued_p != current_row->continued_p |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4472 || desired_row->mode_line_p != current_row->mode_line_p |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4473 || (desired_row->indicate_empty_line_p |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4474 != current_row->indicate_empty_line_p) |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4475 || (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (desired_row) |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4476 != MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (current_row))) |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4477 rif->after_update_window_line_hook (desired_row); |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4478 } |
25012 | 4479 |
4480 /* Update current_row from desired_row. */ | |
4481 make_current (w->desired_matrix, w->current_matrix, vpos); | |
4482 updated_row = NULL; | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4483 return changed_p; |
25012 | 4484 } |
4485 | |
4486 | |
4487 /* Set the cursor after an update of window W. This function may only | |
4488 be called from update_window. */ | |
4489 | |
4490 static void | |
4491 set_window_cursor_after_update (w) | |
4492 struct window *w; | |
4493 { | |
4494 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
4495 int cx, cy, vpos, hpos; | |
4496 | |
4497 /* Not intended for frame matrix updates. */ | |
4498 xassert (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); | |
4499 | |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4500 if (cursor_in_echo_area |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4501 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4502 /* If we are showing a message instead of the mini-buffer, |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4503 show the cursor for the message instead. */ |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4504 && XWINDOW (minibuf_window) == w |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4505 && EQ (minibuf_window, echo_area_window) |
25012 | 4506 /* These cases apply only to the frame that contains |
4507 the active mini-buffer window. */ | |
4508 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f) | |
4509 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window)) | |
4510 { | |
4511 cx = cy = vpos = hpos = 0; | |
4512 | |
4513 if (cursor_in_echo_area >= 0) | |
4514 { | |
4515 /* If the mini-buffer is several lines high, find the last | |
4516 line that has any text on it. Note: either all lines | |
4517 are enabled or none. Otherwise we wouldn't be able to | |
4518 determine Y. */ | |
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4519 struct glyph_row *row, *last_row; |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4520 struct glyph *glyph; |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4521 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4522 |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4523 last_row = NULL; |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4524 for (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, 0); |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4525 row->enabled_p; |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4526 ++row) |
25012 | 4527 { |
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4528 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4529 && row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0].charpos >= 0) |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4530 last_row = row; |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4531 |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4532 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb) |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4533 break; |
25012 | 4534 } |
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4535 |
25012 | 4536 if (last_row) |
4537 { | |
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4538 struct glyph *start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4539 struct glyph *last = start + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4540 |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4541 while (last > start && last->charpos < 0) |
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4542 --last; |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4543 |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4544 for (glyph = start; glyph < last; ++glyph) |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4545 { |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4546 cx += glyph->pixel_width; |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4547 ++hpos; |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4548 } |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4549 |
25012 | 4550 cy = last_row->y; |
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4551 vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_row, w->current_matrix); |
25012 | 4552 } |
4553 } | |
4554 } | |
4555 else | |
4556 { | |
4557 cx = w->cursor.x; | |
4558 cy = w->cursor.y; | |
4559 hpos = w->cursor.hpos; | |
4560 vpos = w->cursor.vpos; | |
4561 } | |
4562 | |
4563 /* Window cursor can be out of sync for horizontally split windows. */ | |
4564 hpos = max (0, hpos); | |
4565 hpos = min (w->current_matrix->matrix_w - 1, hpos); | |
4566 vpos = max (0, vpos); | |
4567 vpos = min (w->current_matrix->nrows - 1, vpos); | |
4568 rif->cursor_to (vpos, hpos, cy, cx); | |
4569 } | |
4570 | |
4571 | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4572 /* Set WINDOW->must_be_updated_p to ON_P for all windows in the window |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4573 tree rooted at W. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4574 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4575 void |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4576 set_window_update_flags (w, on_p) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4577 struct window *w; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4578 int on_p; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4579 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4580 while (w) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4581 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4582 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4583 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4584 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4585 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4586 else |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4587 w->must_be_updated_p = on_p; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4588 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4589 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4590 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4591 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4592 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4593 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4594 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4595 /*********************************************************************** |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4596 Window-Based Scrolling |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4597 ***********************************************************************/ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4598 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4599 /* Structure describing rows in scrolling_window. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4600 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4601 struct row_entry |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4602 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4603 /* Number of occurrences of this row in desired and current matrix. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4604 int old_uses, new_uses; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4605 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4606 /* Vpos of row in new matrix. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4607 int new_line_number; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4608 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4609 /* Bucket index of this row_entry in the hash table row_table. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4610 int bucket; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4611 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4612 /* The row described by this entry. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4613 struct glyph_row *row; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4614 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4615 /* Hash collision chain. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4616 struct row_entry *next; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4617 }; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4618 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4619 /* A pool to allocate row_entry structures from, and the size of the |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4620 pool. The pool is reallocated in scrolling_window when we find |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4621 that we need a larger one. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4622 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4623 static struct row_entry *row_entry_pool; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4624 static int row_entry_pool_size; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4625 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4626 /* Index of next free entry in row_entry_pool. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4627 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4628 static int row_entry_idx; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4629 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4630 /* The hash table used during scrolling, and the table's size. This |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4631 table is used to quickly identify equal rows in the desired and |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4632 current matrix. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4633 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4634 static struct row_entry **row_table; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4635 static int row_table_size; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4636 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4637 /* Vectors of pointers to row_entry structures belonging to the |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4638 current and desired matrix, and the size of the vectors. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4639 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4640 static struct row_entry **old_lines, **new_lines; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4641 static int old_lines_size, new_lines_size; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4642 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4643 /* A pool to allocate run structures from, and its size. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4644 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4645 static struct run *run_pool; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4646 static int runs_size; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4647 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4648 /* A vector of runs of lines found during scrolling. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4649 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4650 static struct run **runs; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4651 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4652 static struct row_entry *add_row_entry P_ ((struct window *, |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4653 struct glyph_row *)); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4654 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4655 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4656 /* Add glyph row ROW to the scrolling hash table during the scrolling |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4657 of window W. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4658 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4659 static INLINE struct row_entry * |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4660 add_row_entry (w, row) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4661 struct window *w; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4662 struct glyph_row *row; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4663 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4664 struct row_entry *entry; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4665 int i = row->hash % row_table_size; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4666 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4667 entry = row_table[i]; |
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
4668 while (entry && !row_equal_p (w, entry->row, row, 1)) |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4669 entry = entry->next; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4670 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4671 if (entry == NULL) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4672 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4673 entry = row_entry_pool + row_entry_idx++; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4674 entry->row = row; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4675 entry->old_uses = entry->new_uses = 0; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4676 entry->new_line_number = 0; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4677 entry->bucket = i; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4678 entry->next = row_table[i]; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4679 row_table[i] = entry; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4680 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4681 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4682 return entry; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4683 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4684 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4685 |
25012 | 4686 /* Try to reuse part of the current display of W by scrolling lines. |
25546 | 4687 HEADER_LINE_P non-zero means W has a top mode line. |
25012 | 4688 |
4689 The algorithm is taken from Communications of the ACM, Apr78 "A | |
4690 Technique for Isolating Differences Between Files." It should take | |
4691 O(N) time. | |
4692 | |
4693 A short outline of the steps of the algorithm | |
4694 | |
4695 1. Skip lines equal at the start and end of both matrices. | |
4696 | |
4697 2. Enter rows in the current and desired matrix into a symbol | |
4698 table, counting how often they appear in both matrices. | |
4699 | |
4700 3. Rows that appear exactly once in both matrices serve as anchors, | |
4701 i.e. we assume that such lines are likely to have been moved. | |
4702 | |
4703 4. Starting from anchor lines, extend regions to be scrolled both | |
4704 forward and backward. | |
4705 | |
4706 Value is | |
4707 | |
4708 -1 if all rows were found to be equal. | |
4709 0 to indicate that we did not scroll the display, or | |
4710 1 if we did scroll. */ | |
4711 | |
4712 static int | |
25546 | 4713 scrolling_window (w, header_line_p) |
25012 | 4714 struct window *w; |
25546 | 4715 int header_line_p; |
25012 | 4716 { |
4717 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix; | |
4718 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = w->current_matrix; | |
4719 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4720 int i, j, first_old, first_new, last_old, last_new; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4721 int nruns, nbytes, n, run_idx; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4722 struct row_entry *entry; |
25012 | 4723 |
4724 /* Skip over rows equal at the start. */ | |
31825
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4725 for (i = header_line_p ? 1 : 0; i < current_matrix->nrows - 1; ++i) |
25012 | 4726 { |
31825
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4727 struct glyph_row *d = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i); |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4728 struct glyph_row *c = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i); |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4729 |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4730 if (c->enabled_p |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4731 && d->enabled_p |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4732 && c->y == d->y |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4733 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (c) <= yb |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4734 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (d) <= yb |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4735 && row_equal_p (w, c, d, 1)) |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4736 { |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4737 assign_row (c, d); |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4738 d->enabled_p = 0; |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4739 } |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4740 else |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4741 break; |
25012 | 4742 } |
4743 | |
4744 /* Give up if some rows in the desired matrix are not enabled. */ | |
4745 if (!MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)->enabled_p) | |
4746 return -1; | |
4747 | |
4748 first_old = first_new = i; | |
4749 | |
4750 /* Set last_new to the index + 1 of the last enabled row in the | |
4751 desired matrix. */ | |
4752 i = first_new + 1; | |
4753 while (i < desired_matrix->nrows - 1 | |
4754 && MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)->enabled_p | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4755 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)) <= yb) |
25012 | 4756 ++i; |
4757 | |
4758 if (!MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)->enabled_p) | |
4759 return 0; | |
4760 | |
4761 last_new = i; | |
4762 | |
4763 /* Set last_old to the index + 1 of the last enabled row in the | |
4764 current matrix. We don't look at the enabled flag here because | |
4765 we plan to reuse part of the display even if other parts are | |
4766 disabled. */ | |
4767 i = first_old + 1; | |
34929
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4768 while (i < current_matrix->nrows - 1) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4769 { |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4770 int bottom = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)); |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4771 if (bottom <= yb) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4772 ++i; |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4773 if (bottom >= yb) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4774 break; |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4775 } |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4776 |
25012 | 4777 last_old = i; |
4778 | |
4779 /* Skip over rows equal at the bottom. */ | |
4780 i = last_new; | |
4781 j = last_old; | |
4782 while (i - 1 > first_new | |
4783 && j - 1 > first_old | |
4784 && MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i - 1)->enabled_p | |
4785 && (MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i - 1)->y | |
4786 == MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, j - 1)->y) | |
4787 && row_equal_p (w, | |
4788 MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i - 1), | |
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
4789 MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, j - 1), 1)) |
25012 | 4790 --i, --j; |
4791 last_new = i; | |
4792 last_old = j; | |
4793 | |
4794 /* Nothing to do if all rows are equal. */ | |
4795 if (last_new == first_new) | |
4796 return 0; | |
4797 | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4798 /* Reallocate vectors, tables etc. if necessary. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4799 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4800 if (current_matrix->nrows > old_lines_size) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4801 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4802 old_lines_size = current_matrix->nrows; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4803 nbytes = old_lines_size * sizeof *old_lines; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4804 old_lines = (struct row_entry **) xrealloc (old_lines, nbytes); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4805 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4806 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4807 if (desired_matrix->nrows > new_lines_size) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4808 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4809 new_lines_size = desired_matrix->nrows; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4810 nbytes = new_lines_size * sizeof *new_lines; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4811 new_lines = (struct row_entry **) xrealloc (new_lines, nbytes); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4812 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4813 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4814 n = desired_matrix->nrows + current_matrix->nrows; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4815 if (3 * n > row_table_size) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4816 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4817 row_table_size = next_almost_prime (3 * n); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4818 nbytes = row_table_size * sizeof *row_table; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4819 row_table = (struct row_entry **) xrealloc (row_table, nbytes); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4820 bzero (row_table, nbytes); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4821 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4822 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4823 if (n > row_entry_pool_size) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4824 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4825 row_entry_pool_size = n; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4826 nbytes = row_entry_pool_size * sizeof *row_entry_pool; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4827 row_entry_pool = (struct row_entry *) xrealloc (row_entry_pool, nbytes); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4828 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4829 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4830 if (desired_matrix->nrows > runs_size) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4831 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4832 runs_size = desired_matrix->nrows; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4833 nbytes = runs_size * sizeof *runs; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4834 runs = (struct run **) xrealloc (runs, nbytes); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4835 nbytes = runs_size * sizeof *run_pool; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4836 run_pool = (struct run *) xrealloc (run_pool, nbytes); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4837 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4838 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4839 nruns = run_idx = 0; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4840 row_entry_idx = 0; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4841 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4842 /* Add rows from the current and desired matrix to the hash table |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4843 row_hash_table to be able to find equal ones quickly. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4844 |
25012 | 4845 for (i = first_old; i < last_old; ++i) |
4846 { | |
4847 if (MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)->enabled_p) | |
4848 { | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4849 entry = add_row_entry (w, MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4850 old_lines[i] = entry; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4851 ++entry->old_uses; |
25012 | 4852 } |
4853 else | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4854 old_lines[i] = NULL; |
25012 | 4855 } |
4856 | |
4857 for (i = first_new; i < last_new; ++i) | |
4858 { | |
4859 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, i)); | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4860 entry = add_row_entry (w, MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4861 ++entry->new_uses; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4862 entry->new_line_number = i; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4863 new_lines[i] = entry; |
25012 | 4864 } |
4865 | |
4866 /* Identify moves based on lines that are unique and equal | |
4867 in both matrices. */ | |
4868 for (i = first_old; i < last_old;) | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4869 if (old_lines[i] |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4870 && old_lines[i]->old_uses == 1 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4871 && old_lines[i]->new_uses == 1) |
25012 | 4872 { |
4873 int j, k; | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4874 int new_line = old_lines[i]->new_line_number; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4875 struct run *run = run_pool + run_idx++; |
25012 | 4876 |
4877 /* Record move. */ | |
4878 run->current_vpos = i; | |
4879 run->current_y = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)->y; | |
4880 run->desired_vpos = new_line; | |
4881 run->desired_y = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, new_line)->y; | |
4882 run->nrows = 1; | |
4883 run->height = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)->height; | |
4884 | |
4885 /* Extend backward. */ | |
4886 j = i - 1; | |
4887 k = new_line - 1; | |
4888 while (j > first_old | |
4889 && k > first_new | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4890 && old_lines[j] == new_lines[k]) |
25012 | 4891 { |
4892 int h = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, j)->height; | |
4893 --run->current_vpos; | |
4894 --run->desired_vpos; | |
4895 ++run->nrows; | |
4896 run->height += h; | |
4897 run->desired_y -= h; | |
4898 run->current_y -= h; | |
4899 --j, --k; | |
4900 } | |
4901 | |
4902 /* Extend forward. */ | |
4903 j = i + 1; | |
4904 k = new_line + 1; | |
4905 while (j < last_old | |
4906 && k < last_new | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4907 && old_lines[j] == new_lines[k]) |
25012 | 4908 { |
4909 int h = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, j)->height; | |
4910 ++run->nrows; | |
4911 run->height += h; | |
4912 ++j, ++k; | |
4913 } | |
4914 | |
4915 /* Insert run into list of all runs. Order runs by copied | |
4916 pixel lines. Note that we record runs that don't have to | |
4917 be copied because they are already in place. This is done | |
4918 because we can avoid calling update_window_line in this | |
4919 case. */ | |
4920 for (j = 0; j < nruns && runs[j]->height > run->height; ++j) | |
4921 ; | |
34203
e55480843a8e
(scrolling_window): Fix code inserting runs in list of all runs.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33763
diff
changeset
|
4922 for (k = nruns; k > j; --k) |
25012 | 4923 runs[k] = runs[k - 1]; |
4924 runs[j] = run; | |
4925 ++nruns; | |
4926 | |
4927 i += run->nrows; | |
4928 } | |
4929 else | |
4930 ++i; | |
4931 | |
4932 /* Do the moves. Do it in a way that we don't overwrite something | |
4933 we want to copy later on. This is not solvable in general | |
4934 because there is only one display and we don't have a way to | |
4935 exchange areas on this display. Example: | |
4936 | |
4937 +-----------+ +-----------+ | |
4938 | A | | B | | |
4939 +-----------+ --> +-----------+ | |
4940 | B | | A | | |
4941 +-----------+ +-----------+ | |
4942 | |
4943 Instead, prefer bigger moves, and invalidate moves that would | |
4944 copy from where we copied to. */ | |
4945 | |
4946 for (i = 0; i < nruns; ++i) | |
4947 if (runs[i]->nrows > 0) | |
4948 { | |
4949 struct run *r = runs[i]; | |
4950 | |
4951 /* Copy on the display. */ | |
4952 if (r->current_y != r->desired_y) | |
4953 { | |
4954 rif->scroll_run_hook (w, r); | |
4955 | |
4956 /* Invalidate runs that copy from where we copied to. */ | |
4957 for (j = i + 1; j < nruns; ++j) | |
4958 { | |
4959 struct run *p = runs[j]; | |
4960 | |
4961 if ((p->current_y >= r->desired_y | |
4962 && p->current_y < r->desired_y + r->height) | |
4963 || (p->current_y + p->height >= r->desired_y | |
4964 && (p->current_y + p->height | |
4965 < r->desired_y + r->height))) | |
4966 p->nrows = 0; | |
4967 } | |
4968 } | |
4969 | |
4970 /* Assign matrix rows. */ | |
4971 for (j = 0; j < r->nrows; ++j) | |
4972 { | |
4973 struct glyph_row *from, *to; | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4974 int to_overlapped_p; |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4975 |
25012 | 4976 to = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, r->desired_vpos + j); |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4977 from = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, r->desired_vpos + j); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4978 to_overlapped_p = to->overlapped_p; |
25012 | 4979 assign_row (to, from); |
4980 to->enabled_p = 1, from->enabled_p = 0; | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4981 to->overlapped_p = to_overlapped_p; |
25012 | 4982 } |
4983 } | |
4984 | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4985 /* Clear the hash table, for the next time. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4986 for (i = 0; i < row_entry_idx; ++i) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4987 row_table[row_entry_pool[i].bucket] = NULL; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4988 |
25012 | 4989 /* Value is non-zero to indicate that we scrolled the display. */ |
4990 return 1; | |
4991 } | |
4992 | |
4993 | |
4994 | |
4995 /************************************************************************ | |
4996 Frame-Based Updates | |
4997 ************************************************************************/ | |
4998 | |
4999 /* Update the desired frame matrix of frame F. | |
5000 | |
5001 FORCE_P non-zero means that the update should not be stopped by | |
5002 pending input. INHIBIT_HAIRY_ID_P non-zero means that scrolling | |
5003 should not be tried. | |
5004 | |
5005 Value is non-zero if update was stopped due to pending input. */ | |
5006 | |
5007 static int | |
5008 update_frame_1 (f, force_p, inhibit_id_p) | |
5009 struct frame *f; | |
5010 int force_p; | |
5011 int inhibit_id_p; | |
5012 { | |
5013 /* Frame matrices to work on. */ | |
5014 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = f->current_matrix; | |
5015 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = f->desired_matrix; | |
5016 int i; | |
314 | 5017 int pause; |
5018 int preempt_count = baud_rate / 2400 + 1; | |
21514 | 5019 extern int input_pending; |
25012 | 5020 |
5021 xassert (current_matrix && desired_matrix); | |
314 | 5022 |
10122
3de6776ae141
(update_frame): Call calculate_costs if baud_rate changed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
9963
diff
changeset
|
5023 if (baud_rate != FRAME_COST_BAUD_RATE (f)) |
3de6776ae141
(update_frame): Call calculate_costs if baud_rate changed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
9963
diff
changeset
|
5024 calculate_costs (f); |
3de6776ae141
(update_frame): Call calculate_costs if baud_rate changed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
9963
diff
changeset
|
5025 |
3357
d9523a958b3c
(update_frame): Make preempt_count positive.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3317
diff
changeset
|
5026 if (preempt_count <= 0) |
d9523a958b3c
(update_frame): Make preempt_count positive.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3317
diff
changeset
|
5027 preempt_count = 1; |
d9523a958b3c
(update_frame): Make preempt_count positive.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3317
diff
changeset
|
5028 |
30720
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
5029 if (redisplay_dont_pause) |
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
5030 force_p = 1; |
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
5031 else if (!force_p && detect_input_pending ()) |
314 | 5032 { |
5033 pause = 1; | |
5034 goto do_pause; | |
5035 } | |
5036 | |
25012 | 5037 /* If we cannot insert/delete lines, it's no use trying it. */ |
314 | 5038 if (!line_ins_del_ok) |
25012 | 5039 inhibit_id_p = 1; |
7188
7da4ad9a2a8f
(update_frame): Move those assignments even farther down.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7179
diff
changeset
|
5040 |
493 | 5041 /* See if any of the desired lines are enabled; don't compute for |
25012 | 5042 i/d line if just want cursor motion. */ |
5043 for (i = 0; i < desired_matrix->nrows; i++) | |
5044 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, i)) | |
314 | 5045 break; |
5046 | |
5047 /* Try doing i/d line, if not yet inhibited. */ | |
25012 | 5048 if (!inhibit_id_p && i < desired_matrix->nrows) |
5049 force_p |= scrolling (f); | |
314 | 5050 |
5051 /* Update the individual lines as needed. Do bottom line first. */ | |
25012 | 5052 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, desired_matrix->nrows - 1)) |
5053 update_frame_line (f, desired_matrix->nrows - 1); | |
5054 | |
5055 /* Now update the rest of the lines. */ | |
5056 for (i = 0; i < desired_matrix->nrows - 1 && (force_p || !input_pending); i++) | |
314 | 5057 { |
25012 | 5058 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, i)) |
314 | 5059 { |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5060 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f)) |
314 | 5061 { |
5062 /* Flush out every so many lines. | |
5063 Also flush out if likely to have more than 1k buffered | |
5064 otherwise. I'm told that some telnet connections get | |
5065 really screwed by more than 1k output at once. */ | |
5066 int outq = PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT (stdout); | |
5067 if (outq > 900 | |
5068 || (outq > 20 && ((i - 1) % preempt_count == 0))) | |
5069 { | |
5070 fflush (stdout); | |
5071 if (preempt_count == 1) | |
5072 { | |
554 | 5073 #ifdef EMACS_OUTQSIZE |
5074 if (EMACS_OUTQSIZE (0, &outq) < 0) | |
314 | 5075 /* Probably not a tty. Ignore the error and reset |
25012 | 5076 * the outq count. */ |
314 | 5077 outq = PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT (stdout); |
5078 #endif | |
5079 outq *= 10; | |
7530
57c2345a9002
(update_frame): Fix test of outq and baud_rate some more.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7529
diff
changeset
|
5080 if (baud_rate <= outq && baud_rate > 0) |
3357
d9523a958b3c
(update_frame): Make preempt_count positive.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3317
diff
changeset
|
5081 sleep (outq / baud_rate); |
314 | 5082 } |
5083 } | |
5084 } | |
5085 | |
16822
483e137d5384
(update_frame): Call detect_input_pending
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16589
diff
changeset
|
5086 if ((i - 1) % preempt_count == 0) |
483e137d5384
(update_frame): Call detect_input_pending
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16589
diff
changeset
|
5087 detect_input_pending (); |
483e137d5384
(update_frame): Call detect_input_pending
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16589
diff
changeset
|
5088 |
25012 | 5089 update_frame_line (f, i); |
314 | 5090 } |
5091 } | |
25012 | 5092 |
764 | 5093 pause = (i < FRAME_HEIGHT (f) - 1) ? i : 0; |
314 | 5094 |
5095 /* Now just clean up termcap drivers and set cursor, etc. */ | |
5096 if (!pause) | |
5097 { | |
12409
6e374b28ecc3
(update_frame): Pretend cursor is in echo area
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12193
diff
changeset
|
5098 if ((cursor_in_echo_area |
25012 | 5099 /* If we are showing a message instead of the mini-buffer, |
12627
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
5100 show the cursor for the message instead of for the |
25012 | 5101 (now hidden) mini-buffer contents. */ |
12627
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
5102 || (EQ (minibuf_window, selected_window) |
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
5103 && EQ (minibuf_window, echo_area_window) |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5104 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))) |
12627
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
5105 /* These cases apply only to the frame that contains |
25012 | 5106 the active mini-buffer window. */ |
12627
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
5107 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f) |
14459
c1d25453a95f
(update_frame): Compare FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW(f)
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
14286
diff
changeset
|
5108 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window)) |
708 | 5109 { |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5110 int top = XINT (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f))->top); |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5111 int row, col; |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5112 |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5113 if (cursor_in_echo_area < 0) |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5114 { |
25012 | 5115 /* Negative value of cursor_in_echo_area means put |
5116 cursor at beginning of line. */ | |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5117 row = top; |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5118 col = 0; |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5119 } |
708 | 5120 else |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5121 { |
25012 | 5122 /* Positive value of cursor_in_echo_area means put |
5123 cursor at the end of the prompt. If the mini-buffer | |
5124 is several lines high, find the last line that has | |
5125 any text on it. */ | |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5126 row = FRAME_HEIGHT (f); |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5127 do |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5128 { |
25012 | 5129 --row; |
5130 col = 0; | |
5131 | |
5132 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (current_matrix, row)) | |
5133 { | |
5134 /* Frame rows are filled up with spaces that | |
5135 must be ignored here. */ | |
5136 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, | |
5137 row); | |
5138 struct glyph *start = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
5139 struct glyph *last = start + r->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
5140 | |
5141 while (last > start | |
5142 && (last - 1)->charpos < 0) | |
5143 --last; | |
5144 | |
5145 col = last - start; | |
5146 } | |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5147 } |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5148 while (row > top && col == 0); |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5149 |
21757
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5150 /* Make sure COL is not out of range. */ |
21763
b685f9451792
(change_frame_size_1): Use FRAME_CURSOR_X_LIMIT.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21757
diff
changeset
|
5151 if (col >= FRAME_CURSOR_X_LIMIT (f)) |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5152 { |
21757
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5153 /* If we have another row, advance cursor into it. */ |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5154 if (row < FRAME_HEIGHT (f) - 1) |
21757
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5155 { |
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5156 col = FRAME_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f); |
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5157 row++; |
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5158 } |
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5159 /* Otherwise move it back in range. */ |
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
5160 else |
21763
b685f9451792
(change_frame_size_1): Use FRAME_CURSOR_X_LIMIT.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21757
diff
changeset
|
5161 col = FRAME_CURSOR_X_LIMIT (f) - 1; |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5162 } |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5163 } |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5164 |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
5165 cursor_to (row, col); |
708 | 5166 } |
314 | 5167 else |
25012 | 5168 { |
5169 /* We have only one cursor on terminal frames. Use it to | |
5170 display the cursor of the selected window. */ | |
5171 struct window *w = XWINDOW (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f)); | |
29687
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5172 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0 |
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5173 /* The cursor vpos may be temporarily out of bounds |
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5174 in the following situation: There is one window, |
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5175 with the cursor in the lower half of it. The window |
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5176 is split, and a message causes a redisplay before |
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5177 a new cursor position has been computed. */ |
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
5178 && w->cursor.vpos < XFASTINT (w->height)) |
25012 | 5179 { |
5180 int x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS (w, w->cursor.hpos); | |
5181 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS (w, w->cursor.vpos); | |
5182 | |
5183 if (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_width)) | |
5184 x += XFASTINT (w->left_margin_width); | |
5185 | |
5186 /* x = max (min (x, FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f) - 1), 0); */ | |
5187 cursor_to (y, x); | |
5188 } | |
5189 } | |
314 | 5190 } |
5191 | |
5192 do_pause: | |
5193 | |
25012 | 5194 clear_desired_matrices (f); |
314 | 5195 return pause; |
5196 } | |
5197 | |
25012 | 5198 |
5199 /* Do line insertions/deletions on frame F for frame-based redisplay. */ | |
314 | 5200 |
21514 | 5201 int |
764 | 5202 scrolling (frame) |
25012 | 5203 struct frame *frame; |
314 | 5204 { |
5205 int unchanged_at_top, unchanged_at_bottom; | |
5206 int window_size; | |
5207 int changed_lines; | |
764 | 5208 int *old_hash = (int *) alloca (FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) * sizeof (int)); |
5209 int *new_hash = (int *) alloca (FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) * sizeof (int)); | |
5210 int *draw_cost = (int *) alloca (FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) * sizeof (int)); | |
10259
48e4dfc6bb43
(scrolling): Fewer restrictions if scroll_region_ok is
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10122
diff
changeset
|
5211 int *old_draw_cost = (int *) alloca (FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) * sizeof (int)); |
314 | 5212 register int i; |
764 | 5213 int free_at_end_vpos = FRAME_HEIGHT (frame); |
25012 | 5214 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = frame->current_matrix; |
5215 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = frame->desired_matrix; | |
5216 | |
5217 if (!current_matrix) | |
5218 abort (); | |
5219 | |
5220 /* Compute hash codes of all the lines. Also calculate number of | |
5221 changed lines, number of unchanged lines at the beginning, and | |
5222 number of unchanged lines at the end. */ | |
314 | 5223 changed_lines = 0; |
5224 unchanged_at_top = 0; | |
764 | 5225 unchanged_at_bottom = FRAME_HEIGHT (frame); |
5226 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_HEIGHT (frame); i++) | |
314 | 5227 { |
5228 /* Give up on this scrolling if some old lines are not enabled. */ | |
25012 | 5229 if (!MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (current_matrix, i)) |
314 | 5230 return 0; |
25012 | 5231 old_hash[i] = line_hash_code (MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)); |
5232 if (! MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, i)) | |
18015
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5233 { |
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5234 /* This line cannot be redrawn, so don't let scrolling mess it. */ |
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5235 new_hash[i] = old_hash[i]; |
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5236 #define INFINITY 1000000 /* Taken from scroll.c */ |
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5237 draw_cost[i] = INFINITY; |
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5238 } |
314 | 5239 else |
18015
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5240 { |
25012 | 5241 new_hash[i] = line_hash_code (MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)); |
5242 draw_cost[i] = line_draw_cost (desired_matrix, i); | |
18015
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
5243 } |
314 | 5244 |
5245 if (old_hash[i] != new_hash[i]) | |
5246 { | |
5247 changed_lines++; | |
764 | 5248 unchanged_at_bottom = FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) - i - 1; |
314 | 5249 } |
5250 else if (i == unchanged_at_top) | |
5251 unchanged_at_top++; | |
25012 | 5252 old_draw_cost[i] = line_draw_cost (current_matrix, i); |
314 | 5253 } |
5254 | |
5255 /* If changed lines are few, don't allow preemption, don't scroll. */ | |
25012 | 5256 if ((!scroll_region_ok && changed_lines < baud_rate / 2400) |
764 | 5257 || unchanged_at_bottom == FRAME_HEIGHT (frame)) |
314 | 5258 return 1; |
5259 | |
764 | 5260 window_size = (FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) - unchanged_at_top |
314 | 5261 - unchanged_at_bottom); |
5262 | |
5263 if (scroll_region_ok) | |
5264 free_at_end_vpos -= unchanged_at_bottom; | |
764 | 5265 else if (memory_below_frame) |
314 | 5266 free_at_end_vpos = -1; |
5267 | |
5268 /* If large window, fast terminal and few lines in common between | |
25012 | 5269 current frame and desired frame, don't bother with i/d calc. */ |
10259
48e4dfc6bb43
(scrolling): Fewer restrictions if scroll_region_ok is
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10122
diff
changeset
|
5270 if (!scroll_region_ok && window_size >= 18 && baud_rate > 2400 |
314 | 5271 && (window_size >= |
5272 10 * scrolling_max_lines_saved (unchanged_at_top, | |
764 | 5273 FRAME_HEIGHT (frame) - unchanged_at_bottom, |
314 | 5274 old_hash, new_hash, draw_cost))) |
5275 return 0; | |
5276 | |
25012 | 5277 if (window_size < 2) |
5278 return 0; | |
5279 | |
764 | 5280 scrolling_1 (frame, window_size, unchanged_at_top, unchanged_at_bottom, |
314 | 5281 draw_cost + unchanged_at_top - 1, |
10259
48e4dfc6bb43
(scrolling): Fewer restrictions if scroll_region_ok is
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10122
diff
changeset
|
5282 old_draw_cost + unchanged_at_top - 1, |
314 | 5283 old_hash + unchanged_at_top - 1, |
5284 new_hash + unchanged_at_top - 1, | |
5285 free_at_end_vpos - unchanged_at_top); | |
5286 | |
5287 return 0; | |
5288 } | |
25012 | 5289 |
5290 | |
5291 /* Count the number of blanks at the start of the vector of glyphs R | |
5292 which is LEN glyphs long. */ | |
5293 | |
5294 static int | |
5295 count_blanks (r, len) | |
5296 struct glyph *r; | |
5297 int len; | |
314 | 5298 { |
25012 | 5299 int i; |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5300 |
25012 | 5301 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i) |
5302 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (r[i])) | |
5303 break; | |
5304 | |
5305 return i; | |
314 | 5306 } |
25012 | 5307 |
5308 | |
5309 /* Count the number of glyphs in common at the start of the glyph | |
5310 vectors STR1 and STR2. END1 is the end of STR1 and END2 is the end | |
5311 of STR2. Value is the number of equal glyphs equal at the start. */ | |
314 | 5312 |
5313 static int | |
25012 | 5314 count_match (str1, end1, str2, end2) |
5315 struct glyph *str1, *end1, *str2, *end2; | |
314 | 5316 { |
25012 | 5317 struct glyph *p1 = str1; |
5318 struct glyph *p2 = str2; | |
5319 | |
5320 while (p1 < end1 | |
5321 && p2 < end2 | |
26998
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
5322 && GLYPH_CHAR_AND_FACE_EQUAL_P (p1, p2)) |
25012 | 5323 ++p1, ++p2; |
5324 | |
5325 return p1 - str1; | |
314 | 5326 } |
5327 | |
25012 | 5328 |
314 | 5329 /* Char insertion/deletion cost vector, from term.c */ |
25012 | 5330 |
314 | 5331 extern int *char_ins_del_vector; |
16267
05ca2cb9fe0f
(make_frame_glyphs, update_line, update_frame)
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16256
diff
changeset
|
5332 #define char_ins_del_cost(f) (&char_ins_del_vector[FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH((f))]) |
314 | 5333 |
25012 | 5334 |
5335 /* Perform a frame-based update on line VPOS in frame FRAME. */ | |
5336 | |
314 | 5337 static void |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5338 update_frame_line (f, vpos) |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5339 struct frame *f; |
314 | 5340 int vpos; |
5341 { | |
25012 | 5342 struct glyph *obody, *nbody, *op1, *op2, *np1, *nend; |
314 | 5343 int tem; |
5344 int osp, nsp, begmatch, endmatch, olen, nlen; | |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5345 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = f->current_matrix; |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5346 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = f->desired_matrix; |
25012 | 5347 struct glyph_row *current_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, vpos); |
5348 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, vpos); | |
5349 int must_write_whole_line_p; | |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5350 int write_spaces_p = must_write_spaces; |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5351 int colored_spaces_p = (FACE_FROM_ID (f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID)->background |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5352 != FACE_TTY_DEFAULT_BG_COLOR); |
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5353 |
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5354 if (colored_spaces_p) |
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5355 write_spaces_p = 1; |
25012 | 5356 |
5357 if (desired_row->inverse_p | |
5358 != (current_row->enabled_p && current_row->inverse_p)) | |
314 | 5359 { |
25012 | 5360 int n = current_row->enabled_p ? current_row->used[TEXT_AREA] : 0; |
5361 change_line_highlight (desired_row->inverse_p, vpos, vpos, n); | |
5362 current_row->enabled_p = 0; | |
314 | 5363 } |
5364 else | |
25012 | 5365 reassert_line_highlight (desired_row->inverse_p, vpos); |
5366 | |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5367 /* Current row not enabled means it has unknown contents. We must |
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5368 write the whole desired line in that case. */ |
25012 | 5369 must_write_whole_line_p = !current_row->enabled_p; |
5370 if (must_write_whole_line_p) | |
314 | 5371 { |
25012 | 5372 obody = 0; |
314 | 5373 olen = 0; |
5374 } | |
5375 else | |
5376 { | |
25012 | 5377 obody = MATRIX_ROW_GLYPH_START (current_matrix, vpos); |
5378 olen = current_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
5379 | |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5380 if (!current_row->inverse_p) |
314 | 5381 { |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5382 /* Ignore trailing spaces, if we can. */ |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5383 if (!write_spaces_p) |
25012 | 5384 while (olen > 0 && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (obody[olen-1])) |
314 | 5385 olen--; |
5386 } | |
5387 else | |
5388 { | |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5389 /* For an inverse-video line, make sure it's filled with |
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5390 spaces all the way to the frame edge so that the reverse |
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5391 video extends all the way across. */ |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5392 while (olen < FRAME_WIDTH (f) - 1) |
25012 | 5393 obody[olen++] = space_glyph; |
314 | 5394 } |
5395 } | |
5396 | |
25012 | 5397 current_row->enabled_p = 1; |
5398 current_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
5399 current_row->inverse_p = desired_row->inverse_p; | |
5400 | |
5401 /* If desired line is empty, just clear the line. */ | |
5402 if (!desired_row->enabled_p) | |
314 | 5403 { |
5404 nlen = 0; | |
5405 goto just_erase; | |
5406 } | |
5407 | |
25012 | 5408 nbody = desired_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; |
5409 nlen = desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
5410 nend = nbody + nlen; | |
5411 | |
5412 /* If display line has unknown contents, write the whole line. */ | |
5413 if (must_write_whole_line_p) | |
5414 { | |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5415 /* Ignore spaces at the end, if we can. */ |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5416 if (!write_spaces_p) |
25313
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5417 while (nlen > 0 && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (nbody[nlen - 1])) |
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5418 --nlen; |
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5419 |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5420 /* Write the contents of the desired line. */ |
25313
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5421 if (nlen) |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5422 { |
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5423 cursor_to (vpos, 0); |
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5424 write_glyphs (nbody, nlen); |
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5425 } |
25313
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5426 |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5427 /* Don't call clear_end_of_line if we already wrote the whole |
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5428 line. The cursor will not be at the right margin in that |
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5429 case but in the line below. */ |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5430 if (nlen < FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)) |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5431 { |
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5432 cursor_to (vpos, nlen); |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5433 clear_end_of_line (FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)); |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5434 } |
28682
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5435 else |
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5436 /* Make sure we are in the right row, otherwise cursor movement |
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5437 with cmgoto might use `ch' in the wrong row. */ |
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5438 cursor_to (vpos, 0); |
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5439 |
25012 | 5440 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, vpos); |
5441 return; | |
5442 } | |
314 | 5443 |
5444 /* Pretend trailing spaces are not there at all, | |
5445 unless for one reason or another we must write all spaces. */ | |
25012 | 5446 if (!desired_row->inverse_p) |
314 | 5447 { |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5448 if (!write_spaces_p) |
25012 | 5449 while (nlen > 0 && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (nbody[nlen - 1])) |
314 | 5450 nlen--; |
5451 } | |
5452 else | |
5453 { | |
25012 | 5454 /* For an inverse-video line, give it extra trailing spaces all |
5455 the way to the frame edge so that the reverse video extends | |
5456 all the way across. */ | |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5457 while (nlen < FRAME_WIDTH (f) - 1) |
25012 | 5458 nbody[nlen++] = space_glyph; |
314 | 5459 } |
5460 | |
5461 /* If there's no i/d char, quickly do the best we can without it. */ | |
5462 if (!char_ins_del_ok) | |
5463 { | |
25012 | 5464 int i, j; |
5465 | |
5466 /* Find the first glyph in desired row that doesn't agree with | |
5467 a glyph in the current row, and write the rest from there on. */ | |
314 | 5468 for (i = 0; i < nlen; i++) |
5469 { | |
25012 | 5470 if (i >= olen || !GLYPH_EQUAL_P (nbody + i, obody + i)) |
314 | 5471 { |
25012 | 5472 /* Find the end of the run of different glyphs. */ |
5473 j = i + 1; | |
5474 while (j < nlen | |
5475 && (j >= olen | |
5476 || !GLYPH_EQUAL_P (nbody + j, obody + j) | |
5477 || CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (nbody[j]))) | |
5478 ++j; | |
5479 | |
5480 /* Output this run of non-matching chars. */ | |
314 | 5481 cursor_to (vpos, i); |
25012 | 5482 write_glyphs (nbody + i, j - i); |
5483 i = j - 1; | |
314 | 5484 |
5485 /* Now find the next non-match. */ | |
5486 } | |
5487 } | |
5488 | |
5489 /* Clear the rest of the line, or the non-clear part of it. */ | |
5490 if (olen > nlen) | |
5491 { | |
5492 cursor_to (vpos, nlen); | |
5493 clear_end_of_line (olen); | |
5494 } | |
5495 | |
25012 | 5496 /* Make current row = desired row. */ |
5497 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, vpos); | |
314 | 5498 return; |
5499 } | |
5500 | |
25012 | 5501 /* Here when CHAR_INS_DEL_OK != 0, i.e. we can insert or delete |
5502 characters in a row. */ | |
5503 | |
314 | 5504 if (!olen) |
5505 { | |
25012 | 5506 /* If current line is blank, skip over initial spaces, if |
5507 possible, and write the rest. */ | |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5508 if (write_spaces_p || desired_row->inverse_p) |
25012 | 5509 nsp = 0; |
5510 else | |
5511 nsp = count_blanks (nbody, nlen); | |
5512 | |
314 | 5513 if (nlen > nsp) |
5514 { | |
5515 cursor_to (vpos, nsp); | |
5516 write_glyphs (nbody + nsp, nlen - nsp); | |
5517 } | |
5518 | |
764 | 5519 /* Exchange contents between current_frame and new_frame. */ |
25012 | 5520 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, vpos); |
314 | 5521 return; |
5522 } | |
5523 | |
5524 /* Compute number of leading blanks in old and new contents. */ | |
25012 | 5525 osp = count_blanks (obody, olen); |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5526 nsp = (desired_row->inverse_p || colored_spaces_p |
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5527 ? 0 |
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5528 : count_blanks (nbody, nlen)); |
25012 | 5529 |
5530 /* Compute number of matching chars starting with first non-blank. */ | |
5531 begmatch = count_match (obody + osp, obody + olen, | |
5532 nbody + nsp, nbody + nlen); | |
314 | 5533 |
5534 /* Spaces in new match implicit space past the end of old. */ | |
5535 /* A bug causing this to be a no-op was fixed in 18.29. */ | |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5536 if (!write_spaces_p && osp + begmatch == olen) |
314 | 5537 { |
5538 np1 = nbody + nsp; | |
25012 | 5539 while (np1 + begmatch < nend && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (np1[begmatch])) |
5540 ++begmatch; | |
314 | 5541 } |
5542 | |
5543 /* Avoid doing insert/delete char | |
5544 just cause number of leading spaces differs | |
25012 | 5545 when the following text does not match. */ |
314 | 5546 if (begmatch == 0 && osp != nsp) |
5547 osp = nsp = min (osp, nsp); | |
5548 | |
5549 /* Find matching characters at end of line */ | |
5550 op1 = obody + olen; | |
5551 np1 = nbody + nlen; | |
5552 op2 = op1 + begmatch - min (olen - osp, nlen - nsp); | |
25012 | 5553 while (op1 > op2 |
5554 && GLYPH_EQUAL_P (op1 - 1, np1 - 1)) | |
314 | 5555 { |
5556 op1--; | |
5557 np1--; | |
5558 } | |
5559 endmatch = obody + olen - op1; | |
5560 | |
5561 /* tem gets the distance to insert or delete. | |
5562 endmatch is how many characters we save by doing so. | |
5563 Is it worth it? */ | |
5564 | |
5565 tem = (nlen - nsp) - (olen - osp); | |
5566 if (endmatch && tem | |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5567 && (!char_ins_del_ok || endmatch <= char_ins_del_cost (f)[tem])) |
314 | 5568 endmatch = 0; |
5569 | |
5570 /* nsp - osp is the distance to insert or delete. | |
5571 If that is nonzero, begmatch is known to be nonzero also. | |
5572 begmatch + endmatch is how much we save by doing the ins/del. | |
5573 Is it worth it? */ | |
5574 | |
5575 if (nsp != osp | |
5576 && (!char_ins_del_ok | |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5577 || begmatch + endmatch <= char_ins_del_cost (f)[nsp - osp])) |
314 | 5578 { |
5579 begmatch = 0; | |
5580 endmatch = 0; | |
5581 osp = nsp = min (osp, nsp); | |
5582 } | |
5583 | |
5584 /* Now go through the line, inserting, writing and | |
5585 deleting as appropriate. */ | |
5586 | |
5587 if (osp > nsp) | |
5588 { | |
5589 cursor_to (vpos, nsp); | |
5590 delete_glyphs (osp - nsp); | |
5591 } | |
5592 else if (nsp > osp) | |
5593 { | |
5594 /* If going to delete chars later in line | |
5595 and insert earlier in the line, | |
5596 must delete first to avoid losing data in the insert */ | |
5597 if (endmatch && nlen < olen + nsp - osp) | |
5598 { | |
5599 cursor_to (vpos, nlen - endmatch + osp - nsp); | |
5600 delete_glyphs (olen + nsp - osp - nlen); | |
5601 olen = nlen - (nsp - osp); | |
5602 } | |
5603 cursor_to (vpos, osp); | |
25012 | 5604 insert_glyphs (0, nsp - osp); |
314 | 5605 } |
5606 olen += nsp - osp; | |
5607 | |
5608 tem = nsp + begmatch + endmatch; | |
5609 if (nlen != tem || olen != tem) | |
5610 { | |
5611 if (!endmatch || nlen == olen) | |
5612 { | |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5613 /* If new text being written reaches right margin, there is |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5614 no need to do clear-to-eol at the end of this function |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5615 (and it would not be safe, since cursor is not going to |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5616 be "at the margin" after the text is done). */ |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5617 if (nlen == FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)) |
314 | 5618 olen = 0; |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5619 |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5620 /* Function write_glyphs is prepared to do nothing |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5621 if passed a length <= 0. Check it here to avoid |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5622 unnecessary cursor movement. */ |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5623 if (nlen - tem > 0) |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5624 { |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5625 cursor_to (vpos, nsp + begmatch); |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5626 write_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch, nlen - tem); |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5627 } |
314 | 5628 } |
5629 else if (nlen > olen) | |
5630 { | |
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5631 /* Here, we used to have the following simple code: |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5632 ---------------------------------------- |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5633 write_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch, olen - tem); |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5634 insert_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch + olen - tem, nlen - olen); |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5635 ---------------------------------------- |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5636 but it doesn't work if nbody[nsp + begmatch + olen - tem] |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5637 is a padding glyph. */ |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5638 int out = olen - tem; /* Columns to be overwritten originally. */ |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5639 int del; |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5640 |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5641 cursor_to (vpos, nsp + begmatch); |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5642 |
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5643 /* Calculate columns we can actually overwrite. */ |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5644 while (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (nbody[nsp + begmatch + out])) |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5645 out--; |
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5646 write_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch, out); |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5647 |
25012 | 5648 /* If we left columns to be overwritten, we must delete them. */ |
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5649 del = olen - tem - out; |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5650 if (del > 0) |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5651 delete_glyphs (del); |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5652 |
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5653 /* At last, we insert columns not yet written out. */ |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5654 insert_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch + out, nlen - olen + del); |
314 | 5655 olen = nlen; |
5656 } | |
5657 else if (olen > nlen) | |
5658 { | |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5659 cursor_to (vpos, nsp + begmatch); |
314 | 5660 write_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch, nlen - tem); |
5661 delete_glyphs (olen - nlen); | |
5662 olen = nlen; | |
5663 } | |
5664 } | |
5665 | |
5666 just_erase: | |
5667 /* If any unerased characters remain after the new line, erase them. */ | |
5668 if (olen > nlen) | |
5669 { | |
5670 cursor_to (vpos, nlen); | |
5671 clear_end_of_line (olen); | |
5672 } | |
5673 | |
764 | 5674 /* Exchange contents between current_frame and new_frame. */ |
25012 | 5675 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, vpos); |
314 | 5676 } |
25012 | 5677 |
5678 | |
314 | 5679 |
25012 | 5680 /*********************************************************************** |
5681 X/Y Position -> Buffer Position | |
5682 ***********************************************************************/ | |
5683 | |
5684 /* Return the character position of the character at window relative | |
5685 pixel position (*X, *Y). *X and *Y are adjusted to character | |
5686 boundaries. */ | |
5687 | |
5688 int | |
5689 buffer_posn_from_coords (w, x, y) | |
5690 struct window *w; | |
5691 int *x, *y; | |
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
5692 { |
25012 | 5693 struct it it; |
5694 struct buffer *old_current_buffer = current_buffer; | |
5695 struct text_pos startp; | |
5696 int left_area_width; | |
5697 | |
5698 current_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer); | |
5699 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start); | |
5700 CHARPOS (startp) = min (ZV, max (BEGV, CHARPOS (startp))); | |
5701 BYTEPOS (startp) = min (ZV_BYTE, max (BEGV_BYTE, BYTEPOS (startp))); | |
5702 start_display (&it, w, startp); | |
5703 | |
5704 left_area_width = WINDOW_DISPLAY_LEFT_AREA_PIXEL_WIDTH (w); | |
5705 move_it_to (&it, -1, *x + it.first_visible_x - left_area_width, *y, -1, | |
5706 MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y); | |
5707 | |
5708 *x = it.current_x - it.first_visible_x + left_area_width; | |
5709 *y = it.current_y; | |
5710 current_buffer = old_current_buffer; | |
5711 return IT_CHARPOS (it); | |
5712 } | |
5713 | |
5714 | |
5715 /* Value is the string under window-relative coordinates X/Y in the | |
5716 mode or top line of window W, or nil if none. MODE_LINE_P non-zero | |
5717 means look at the mode line. *CHARPOS is set to the position in | |
5718 the string returned. */ | |
5719 | |
5720 Lisp_Object | |
5721 mode_line_string (w, x, y, mode_line_p, charpos) | |
5722 struct window *w; | |
30713
fee809f81f97
(mode_line_string): Declare parameter MODE_LINE_P.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30323
diff
changeset
|
5723 int x, y, mode_line_p; |
25012 | 5724 int *charpos; |
5725 { | |
5726 struct glyph_row *row; | |
5727 struct glyph *glyph, *end; | |
5728 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
5729 int x0; | |
5730 Lisp_Object string = Qnil; | |
5731 | |
5732 if (mode_line_p) | |
5733 row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix); | |
5734 else | |
25546 | 5735 row = MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix); |
25012 | 5736 |
5737 if (row->mode_line_p && row->enabled_p) | |
11919
31cb053405f2
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Record frame names
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
5738 { |
25012 | 5739 /* The mode lines are displayed over scroll bars and bitmap |
5740 areas, and X is window-relative. Correct X by the scroll bar | |
5741 and bitmap area width. */ | |
5742 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_LEFT (f)) | |
5743 x += FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f); | |
25459
293b78b9ff60
(mode_line_string): Add FRAME_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25385
diff
changeset
|
5744 x += FRAME_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f); |
25012 | 5745 |
5746 /* Find the glyph under X. If we find one with a string object, | |
5747 it's the one we were looking for. */ | |
5748 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
5749 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
5750 for (x0 = 0; glyph < end; x0 += glyph->pixel_width, ++glyph) | |
5751 if (x >= x0 && x < x0 + glyph->pixel_width) | |
5752 { | |
5753 string = glyph->object; | |
5754 *charpos = glyph->charpos; | |
5755 break; | |
5756 } | |
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
5757 } |
25012 | 5758 |
5759 return string; | |
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
5760 } |
25012 | 5761 |
5762 | |
5763 /*********************************************************************** | |
5764 Changing Frame Sizes | |
5765 ***********************************************************************/ | |
314 | 5766 |
5767 #ifdef SIGWINCH | |
25012 | 5768 |
493 | 5769 SIGTYPE |
10745
a553a08f5785
(window_change_signal): Add ignored argument.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10259
diff
changeset
|
5770 window_change_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */ |
25012 | 5771 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */ |
314 | 5772 { |
5773 int width, height; | |
31093
6da961dff718
Include keyboard.h before frame.h.
Andrew Innes <andrewi@gnu.org>
parents:
30720
diff
changeset
|
5774 #ifndef USE_CRT_DLL |
314 | 5775 extern int errno; |
31093
6da961dff718
Include keyboard.h before frame.h.
Andrew Innes <andrewi@gnu.org>
parents:
30720
diff
changeset
|
5776 #endif |
314 | 5777 int old_errno = errno; |
5778 | |
764 | 5779 get_frame_size (&width, &height); |
314 | 5780 |
764 | 5781 /* The frame size change obviously applies to a termcap-controlled |
5782 frame. Find such a frame in the list, and assume it's the only | |
314 | 5783 one (since the redisplay code always writes to stdout, not a |
764 | 5784 FILE * specified in the frame structure). Record the new size, |
314 | 5785 but don't reallocate the data structures now. Let that be done |
5786 later outside of the signal handler. */ | |
5787 | |
5788 { | |
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5789 Lisp_Object tail, frame; |
314 | 5790 |
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5791 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) |
314 | 5792 { |
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5793 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (XFRAME (frame))) |
314 | 5794 { |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5795 change_frame_size (XFRAME (frame), height, width, 0, 1, 0); |
314 | 5796 break; |
5797 } | |
5798 } | |
5799 } | |
5800 | |
5801 signal (SIGWINCH, window_change_signal); | |
5802 errno = old_errno; | |
5803 } | |
5804 #endif /* SIGWINCH */ | |
5805 | |
5806 | |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5807 /* Do any change in frame size that was requested by a signal. SAFE |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5808 non-zero means this function is called from a place where it is |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5809 safe to change frame sizes while a redisplay is in progress. */ |
314 | 5810 |
21514 | 5811 void |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5812 do_pending_window_change (safe) |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5813 int safe; |
314 | 5814 { |
5815 /* If window_change_signal should have run before, run it now. */ | |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5816 if (redisplaying_p && !safe) |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5817 return; |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5818 |
314 | 5819 while (delayed_size_change) |
5820 { | |
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5821 Lisp_Object tail, frame; |
314 | 5822 |
5823 delayed_size_change = 0; | |
5824 | |
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5825 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) |
314 | 5826 { |
25012 | 5827 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame); |
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5828 |
764 | 5829 int height = FRAME_NEW_HEIGHT (f); |
5830 int width = FRAME_NEW_WIDTH (f); | |
314 | 5831 |
3449
ad455da9b789
(do_pending_window_change): No need to clear
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3357
diff
changeset
|
5832 if (height != 0 || width != 0) |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5833 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 0, safe); |
314 | 5834 } |
5835 } | |
5836 } | |
5837 | |
5838 | |
764 | 5839 /* Change the frame height and/or width. Values may be given as zero to |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5840 indicate no change is to take place. |
314 | 5841 |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5842 If DELAY is non-zero, then assume we're being called from a signal |
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5843 handler, and queue the change for later - perhaps the next |
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5844 redisplay. Since this tries to resize windows, we can't call it |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5845 from a signal handler. |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5846 |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5847 SAFE non-zero means this function is called from a place where it's |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5848 safe to change frame sizes while a redisplay is in progress. */ |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5849 |
21514 | 5850 void |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5851 change_frame_size (f, newheight, newwidth, pretend, delay, safe) |
25012 | 5852 register struct frame *f; |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5853 int newheight, newwidth, pretend, delay, safe; |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5854 { |
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5855 Lisp_Object tail, frame; |
16881
245ba9f2781a
(change_frame_size_1): Reject new sizes if they cause overflow.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16822
diff
changeset
|
5856 |
15395
b584c2db055f
(change_frame_size, remake_frame_glyphs): Use FRAME_WINDOW_P.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15394
diff
changeset
|
5857 if (! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5858 { |
15394
8d01f71c4797
(Fredraw_frame, remake_frame_glyphs)
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15282
diff
changeset
|
5859 /* When using termcap, or on MS-DOS, all frames use |
8d01f71c4797
(Fredraw_frame, remake_frame_glyphs)
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15282
diff
changeset
|
5860 the same screen, so a change in size affects all frames. */ |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5861 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) |
15395
b584c2db055f
(change_frame_size, remake_frame_glyphs): Use FRAME_WINDOW_P.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15394
diff
changeset
|
5862 if (! FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (frame))) |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5863 change_frame_size_1 (XFRAME (frame), newheight, newwidth, |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5864 pretend, delay, safe); |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5865 } |
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5866 else |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5867 change_frame_size_1 (f, newheight, newwidth, pretend, delay, safe); |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5868 } |
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5869 |
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5870 static void |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5871 change_frame_size_1 (f, newheight, newwidth, pretend, delay, safe) |
25012 | 5872 register struct frame *f; |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5873 int newheight, newwidth, pretend, delay, safe; |
314 | 5874 { |
16256
1ce0cb94fa68
(preserve_other_columns, preserve_my_columns): Use new
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16195
diff
changeset
|
5875 int new_frame_window_width; |
19627
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5876 int count = specpdl_ptr - specpdl; |
16881
245ba9f2781a
(change_frame_size_1): Reject new sizes if they cause overflow.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16822
diff
changeset
|
5877 |
314 | 5878 /* If we can't deal with the change now, queue it for later. */ |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5879 if (delay || (redisplaying_p && !safe)) |
314 | 5880 { |
25012 | 5881 FRAME_NEW_HEIGHT (f) = newheight; |
5882 FRAME_NEW_WIDTH (f) = newwidth; | |
314 | 5883 delayed_size_change = 1; |
5884 return; | |
5885 } | |
5886 | |
764 | 5887 /* This size-change overrides any pending one for this frame. */ |
25012 | 5888 FRAME_NEW_HEIGHT (f) = 0; |
5889 FRAME_NEW_WIDTH (f) = 0; | |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5890 |
3449
ad455da9b789
(do_pending_window_change): No need to clear
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3357
diff
changeset
|
5891 /* If an argument is zero, set it to the current value. */ |
15896
3a3c30116313
(change_frame_size_1): Clean up conditional.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
15687
diff
changeset
|
5892 if (newheight == 0) |
25012 | 5893 newheight = FRAME_HEIGHT (f); |
15896
3a3c30116313
(change_frame_size_1): Clean up conditional.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
15687
diff
changeset
|
5894 if (newwidth == 0) |
25012 | 5895 newwidth = FRAME_WIDTH (f); |
5896 | |
5897 /* Compute width of windows in F. | |
5898 This is the width of the frame without vertical scroll bars. */ | |
5899 new_frame_window_width = FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH_ARG (f, newwidth); | |
16881
245ba9f2781a
(change_frame_size_1): Reject new sizes if they cause overflow.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16822
diff
changeset
|
5900 |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5901 /* Round up to the smallest acceptable size. */ |
25012 | 5902 check_frame_size (f, &newheight, &newwidth); |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5903 |
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5904 /* If we're not changing the frame size, quit now. */ |
25012 | 5905 if (newheight == FRAME_HEIGHT (f) |
5906 && new_frame_window_width == FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)) | |
314 | 5907 return; |
5908 | |
15078 | 5909 BLOCK_INPUT; |
5910 | |
14286
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5911 #ifdef MSDOS |
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5912 /* We only can set screen dimensions to certain values supported |
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5913 by our video hardware. Try to find the smallest size greater |
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5914 or equal to the requested dimensions. */ |
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5915 dos_set_window_size (&newheight, &newwidth); |
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5916 #endif |
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5917 |
25012 | 5918 if (newheight != FRAME_HEIGHT (f)) |
314 | 5919 { |
25012 | 5920 if (FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f) && !FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f)) |
314 | 5921 { |
25012 | 5922 /* Frame has both root and mini-buffer. */ |
5923 XSETFASTINT (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))->top, | |
5924 FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)); | |
5925 set_window_height (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), | |
5926 (newheight | |
5927 - 1 | |
5928 - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)), | |
5929 0); | |
5930 XSETFASTINT (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f))->top, | |
9303
3115ae493c30
(direct_output_for_insert, direct_output_forward_char, change_frame_size,
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
9264
diff
changeset
|
5931 newheight - 1); |
25012 | 5932 set_window_height (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), 1, 0); |
314 | 5933 } |
5934 else | |
764 | 5935 /* Frame has just one top-level window. */ |
25012 | 5936 set_window_height (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), |
5937 newheight - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f), 0); | |
5938 | |
5939 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) && !pretend) | |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5940 FrameRows = newheight; |
314 | 5941 } |
5942 | |
25012 | 5943 if (new_frame_window_width != FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f)) |
314 | 5944 { |
25012 | 5945 set_window_width (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), new_frame_window_width, 0); |
5946 if (FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)) | |
5947 set_window_width (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), new_frame_window_width, 0); | |
5948 | |
5949 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) && !pretend) | |
764 | 5950 FrameCols = newwidth; |
25012 | 5951 |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
5952 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
5953 XSETFASTINT (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->width, newwidth); |
314 | 5954 } |
5955 | |
25012 | 5956 FRAME_HEIGHT (f) = newheight; |
5957 SET_FRAME_WIDTH (f, newwidth); | |
5958 | |
5959 { | |
5960 struct window *w = XWINDOW (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f)); | |
5961 int text_area_x, text_area_y, text_area_width, text_area_height; | |
5962 | |
5963 window_box (w, TEXT_AREA, &text_area_x, &text_area_y, &text_area_width, | |
5964 &text_area_height); | |
5965 if (w->cursor.x >= text_area_x + text_area_width) | |
5966 w->cursor.hpos = w->cursor.x = 0; | |
5967 if (w->cursor.y >= text_area_y + text_area_height) | |
5968 w->cursor.vpos = w->cursor.y = 0; | |
5969 } | |
5970 | |
5971 adjust_glyphs (f); | |
5972 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); | |
5973 calculate_costs (f); | |
15065 | 5974 |
5975 UNBLOCK_INPUT; | |
17282
5023bea28298
(change_frame_size_1): Call Fset_window_buffer,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17015
diff
changeset
|
5976 |
19627
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5977 record_unwind_protect (Fset_buffer, Fcurrent_buffer ()); |
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5978 |
17282
5023bea28298
(change_frame_size_1): Call Fset_window_buffer,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17015
diff
changeset
|
5979 /* This isn't quite a no-op: it runs window-configuration-change-hook. */ |
25012 | 5980 Fset_window_buffer (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f), |
5981 XWINDOW (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f))->buffer); | |
19627
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5982 |
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5983 unbind_to (count, Qnil); |
314 | 5984 } |
25012 | 5985 |
5986 | |
314 | 5987 |
25012 | 5988 /*********************************************************************** |
5989 Terminal Related Lisp Functions | |
5990 ***********************************************************************/ | |
5991 | |
5992 DEFUN ("open-termscript", Fopen_termscript, Sopen_termscript, | |
5993 1, 1, "FOpen termscript file: ", | |
5994 "Start writing all terminal output to FILE as well as the terminal.\n\ | |
5995 FILE = nil means just close any termscript file currently open.") | |
5996 (file) | |
5997 Lisp_Object file; | |
5998 { | |
5999 if (termscript != 0) fclose (termscript); | |
6000 termscript = 0; | |
6001 | |
6002 if (! NILP (file)) | |
6003 { | |
6004 file = Fexpand_file_name (file, Qnil); | |
6005 termscript = fopen (XSTRING (file)->data, "w"); | |
6006 if (termscript == 0) | |
6007 report_file_error ("Opening termscript", Fcons (file, Qnil)); | |
6008 } | |
6009 return Qnil; | |
6010 } | |
6011 | |
6012 | |
314 | 6013 DEFUN ("send-string-to-terminal", Fsend_string_to_terminal, |
6014 Ssend_string_to_terminal, 1, 1, 0, | |
6015 "Send STRING to the terminal without alteration.\n\ | |
6016 Control characters in STRING will have terminal-dependent effects.") | |
14068
a3c83dde295e
(Fsend_string_to_terminal, Fsit_for): Harmonize arguments with
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
13526
diff
changeset
|
6017 (string) |
a3c83dde295e
(Fsend_string_to_terminal, Fsit_for): Harmonize arguments with
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
13526
diff
changeset
|
6018 Lisp_Object string; |
314 | 6019 { |
20618
d5acac3af6e3
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Use size_byte.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19627
diff
changeset
|
6020 /* ??? Perhaps we should do something special for multibyte strings here. */ |
14068
a3c83dde295e
(Fsend_string_to_terminal, Fsit_for): Harmonize arguments with
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
13526
diff
changeset
|
6021 CHECK_STRING (string, 0); |
21244
50929073a0ba
Use STRING_BYTES and SET_STRING_BYTES.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
20708
diff
changeset
|
6022 fwrite (XSTRING (string)->data, 1, STRING_BYTES (XSTRING (string)), stdout); |
314 | 6023 fflush (stdout); |
6024 if (termscript) | |
6025 { | |
21244
50929073a0ba
Use STRING_BYTES and SET_STRING_BYTES.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
20708
diff
changeset
|
6026 fwrite (XSTRING (string)->data, 1, STRING_BYTES (XSTRING (string)), |
50929073a0ba
Use STRING_BYTES and SET_STRING_BYTES.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
20708
diff
changeset
|
6027 termscript); |
314 | 6028 fflush (termscript); |
6029 } | |
6030 return Qnil; | |
6031 } | |
6032 | |
25012 | 6033 |
314 | 6034 DEFUN ("ding", Fding, Sding, 0, 1, 0, |
6035 "Beep, or flash the screen.\n\ | |
6036 Also, unless an argument is given,\n\ | |
6037 terminate any keyboard macro currently executing.") | |
6038 (arg) | |
6039 Lisp_Object arg; | |
6040 { | |
493 | 6041 if (!NILP (arg)) |
314 | 6042 { |
649
61deba7b73b6
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
587
diff
changeset
|
6043 if (noninteractive) |
61deba7b73b6
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
587
diff
changeset
|
6044 putchar (07); |
61deba7b73b6
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
587
diff
changeset
|
6045 else |
61deba7b73b6
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
587
diff
changeset
|
6046 ring_bell (); |
314 | 6047 fflush (stdout); |
6048 } | |
6049 else | |
6050 bitch_at_user (); | |
6051 | |
6052 return Qnil; | |
6053 } | |
6054 | |
21514 | 6055 void |
314 | 6056 bitch_at_user () |
6057 { | |
6058 if (noninteractive) | |
6059 putchar (07); | |
25012 | 6060 else if (!INTERACTIVE) /* Stop executing a keyboard macro. */ |
314 | 6061 error ("Keyboard macro terminated by a command ringing the bell"); |
6062 else | |
6063 ring_bell (); | |
6064 fflush (stdout); | |
6065 } | |
6066 | |
25012 | 6067 |
6068 | |
6069 /*********************************************************************** | |
6070 Sleeping, Waiting | |
6071 ***********************************************************************/ | |
6072 | |
314 | 6073 DEFUN ("sleep-for", Fsleep_for, Ssleep_for, 1, 2, 0, |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6074 "Pause, without updating display, for SECONDS seconds.\n\ |
2648 | 6075 SECONDS may be a floating-point value, meaning that you can wait for a\n\ |
6076 fraction of a second. Optional second arg MILLISECONDS specifies an\n\ | |
6077 additional wait period, in milliseconds; this may be useful if your\n\ | |
6078 Emacs was built without floating point support.\n\ | |
6079 \(Not all operating systems support waiting for a fraction of a second.)") | |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6080 (seconds, milliseconds) |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6081 Lisp_Object seconds, milliseconds; |
314 | 6082 { |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6083 int sec, usec; |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6084 |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6085 if (NILP (milliseconds)) |
9264
9338a124ea84
(redraw_frame, Fsleep_for, sit_for, Fsit_for): Use new accessor macros instead
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
8903
diff
changeset
|
6086 XSETINT (milliseconds, 0); |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6087 else |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6088 CHECK_NUMBER (milliseconds, 1); |
2648 | 6089 usec = XINT (milliseconds) * 1000; |
6090 | |
6091 { | |
6092 double duration = extract_float (seconds); | |
6093 sec = (int) duration; | |
6094 usec += (duration - sec) * 1000000; | |
6095 } | |
314 | 6096 |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6097 #ifndef EMACS_HAS_USECS |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6098 if (sec == 0 && usec != 0) |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6099 error ("millisecond `sleep-for' not supported on %s", SYSTEM_TYPE); |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6100 #endif |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6101 |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6102 /* Assure that 0 <= usec < 1000000. */ |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6103 if (usec < 0) |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6104 { |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6105 /* We can't rely on the rounding being correct if user is negative. */ |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6106 if (-1000000 < usec) |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6107 sec--, usec += 1000000; |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6108 else |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6109 sec -= -usec / 1000000, usec = 1000000 - (-usec % 1000000); |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6110 } |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6111 else |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6112 sec += usec / 1000000, usec %= 1000000; |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6113 |
14646
68fe10d1abd0
(Fsleep_for): Accept sub-second intervals.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
14459
diff
changeset
|
6114 if (sec < 0 || (sec == 0 && usec == 0)) |
314 | 6115 return Qnil; |
6116 | |
650 | 6117 { |
6118 Lisp_Object zero; | |
6119 | |
9303
3115ae493c30
(direct_output_for_insert, direct_output_forward_char, change_frame_size,
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
9264
diff
changeset
|
6120 XSETFASTINT (zero, 0); |
650 | 6121 wait_reading_process_input (sec, usec, zero, 0); |
6122 } | |
587 | 6123 |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6124 /* We should always have wait_reading_process_input; we have a dummy |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6125 implementation for systems which don't support subprocesses. */ |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6126 #if 0 |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6127 /* No wait_reading_process_input */ |
314 | 6128 immediate_quit = 1; |
6129 QUIT; | |
6130 | |
6131 #ifdef VMS | |
6132 sys_sleep (sec); | |
6133 #else /* not VMS */ | |
6134 /* The reason this is done this way | |
6135 (rather than defined (H_S) && defined (H_T)) | |
6136 is because the VMS preprocessor doesn't grok `defined' */ | |
6137 #ifdef HAVE_SELECT | |
554 | 6138 EMACS_GET_TIME (end_time); |
6139 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (timeout, sec, usec); | |
587 | 6140 EMACS_ADD_TIME (end_time, end_time, timeout); |
554 | 6141 |
314 | 6142 while (1) |
6143 { | |
554 | 6144 EMACS_GET_TIME (timeout); |
6145 EMACS_SUB_TIME (timeout, end_time, timeout); | |
6146 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (timeout) | |
6147 || !select (1, 0, 0, 0, &timeout)) | |
314 | 6148 break; |
6149 } | |
6150 #else /* not HAVE_SELECT */ | |
6151 sleep (sec); | |
6152 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */ | |
6153 #endif /* not VMS */ | |
6154 | |
6155 immediate_quit = 0; | |
6156 #endif /* no subprocesses */ | |
6157 | |
6158 return Qnil; | |
6159 } | |
6160 | |
25012 | 6161 |
650 | 6162 /* This is just like wait_reading_process_input, except that |
6163 it does the redisplay. | |
6164 | |
5223
db2e7e6a488e
(Fsit_for): Call prepare_menu_bars.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
5218
diff
changeset
|
6165 It's also much like Fsit_for, except that it can be used for |
11411
91bcce2fd486
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Ignore buffers whose names start with space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
11235
diff
changeset
|
6166 waiting for input as well. */ |
650 | 6167 |
6168 Lisp_Object | |
17961
86ae1679df19
(sit_for): New arg initial_display.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17895
diff
changeset
|
6169 sit_for (sec, usec, reading, display, initial_display) |
86ae1679df19
(sit_for): New arg initial_display.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17895
diff
changeset
|
6170 int sec, usec, reading, display, initial_display; |
314 | 6171 { |
650 | 6172 Lisp_Object read_kbd; |
314 | 6173 |
14964
9938201005a3
(sit_for): Call swallow_events.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
14903
diff
changeset
|
6174 swallow_events (display); |
9938201005a3
(sit_for): Call swallow_events.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
14903
diff
changeset
|
6175 |
14757
99125e1e8bac
(sit_for): Pass DISPLAY to detect_input_pending_run_timers.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
14646
diff
changeset
|
6176 if (detect_input_pending_run_timers (display)) |
314 | 6177 return Qnil; |
650 | 6178 |
17961
86ae1679df19
(sit_for): New arg initial_display.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17895
diff
changeset
|
6179 if (initial_display) |
35336
002c02db42d3
Call redisplay_preserve_echo_area with additional arg.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35307
diff
changeset
|
6180 redisplay_preserve_echo_area (2); |
314 | 6181 |
673 | 6182 if (sec == 0 && usec == 0) |
6183 return Qt; | |
6184 | |
314 | 6185 #ifdef SIGIO |
1915
98ecf99d7b1a
* dispnew.c (sit_for): Pass the correct number of arguments to
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1872
diff
changeset
|
6186 gobble_input (0); |
650 | 6187 #endif |
6188 | |
9264
9338a124ea84
(redraw_frame, Fsleep_for, sit_for, Fsit_for): Use new accessor macros instead
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
8903
diff
changeset
|
6189 XSETINT (read_kbd, reading ? -1 : 1); |
650 | 6190 wait_reading_process_input (sec, usec, read_kbd, display); |
6191 | |
314 | 6192 return detect_input_pending () ? Qnil : Qt; |
6193 } | |
6194 | |
25012 | 6195 |
650 | 6196 DEFUN ("sit-for", Fsit_for, Ssit_for, 1, 3, 0, |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6197 "Perform redisplay, then wait for SECONDS seconds or until input is available.\n\ |
2648 | 6198 SECONDS may be a floating-point value, meaning that you can wait for a\n\ |
6199 fraction of a second. Optional second arg MILLISECONDS specifies an\n\ | |
6200 additional wait period, in milliseconds; this may be useful if your\n\ | |
6201 Emacs was built without floating point support.\n\ | |
6202 \(Not all operating systems support waiting for a fraction of a second.)\n\ | |
14068
a3c83dde295e
(Fsend_string_to_terminal, Fsit_for): Harmonize arguments with
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
13526
diff
changeset
|
6203 Optional third arg NODISP non-nil means don't redisplay, just wait for input.\n\ |
650 | 6204 Redisplay is preempted as always if input arrives, and does not happen\n\ |
6205 if input is available before it starts.\n\ | |
6206 Value is t if waited the full time with no input arriving.") | |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6207 (seconds, milliseconds, nodisp) |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6208 Lisp_Object seconds, milliseconds, nodisp; |
650 | 6209 { |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6210 int sec, usec; |
650 | 6211 |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6212 if (NILP (milliseconds)) |
9264
9338a124ea84
(redraw_frame, Fsleep_for, sit_for, Fsit_for): Use new accessor macros instead
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
8903
diff
changeset
|
6213 XSETINT (milliseconds, 0); |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6214 else |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6215 CHECK_NUMBER (milliseconds, 1); |
2648 | 6216 usec = XINT (milliseconds) * 1000; |
6217 | |
6218 { | |
6219 double duration = extract_float (seconds); | |
6220 sec = (int) duration; | |
6221 usec += (duration - sec) * 1000000; | |
6222 } | |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6223 |
650 | 6224 #ifndef EMACS_HAS_USECS |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6225 if (usec != 0 && sec == 0) |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6226 error ("millisecond `sit-for' not supported on %s", SYSTEM_TYPE); |
650 | 6227 #endif |
6228 | |
17961
86ae1679df19
(sit_for): New arg initial_display.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17895
diff
changeset
|
6229 return sit_for (sec, usec, 0, NILP (nodisp), NILP (nodisp)); |
650 | 6230 } |
25012 | 6231 |
6232 | |
314 | 6233 |
25012 | 6234 /*********************************************************************** |
6235 Other Lisp Functions | |
6236 ***********************************************************************/ | |
6237 | |
6238 /* A vector of size >= 2 * NFRAMES + 3 * NBUFFERS + 1, containing the | |
6239 session's frames, frame names, buffers, buffer-read-only flags, and | |
6240 buffer-modified-flags, and a trailing sentinel (so we don't need to | |
6241 add length checks). */ | |
6242 | |
6243 static Lisp_Object frame_and_buffer_state; | |
6244 | |
6245 | |
6246 DEFUN ("frame-or-buffer-changed-p", Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p, | |
6247 Sframe_or_buffer_changed_p, 0, 0, 0, | |
6248 "Return non-nil if the frame and buffer state appears to have changed.\n\ | |
6249 The state variable is an internal vector containing all frames and buffers,\n\ | |
6250 aside from buffers whose names start with space,\n\ | |
6251 along with the buffers' read-only and modified flags, which allows a fast\n\ | |
6252 check to see whether the menu bars might need to be recomputed.\n\ | |
6253 If this function returns non-nil, it updates the internal vector to reflect\n\ | |
6254 the current state.\n") | |
6255 () | |
6256 { | |
6257 Lisp_Object tail, frame, buf; | |
6258 Lisp_Object *vecp; | |
6259 int n; | |
6260 | |
6261 vecp = XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->contents; | |
6262 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
6263 { | |
6264 if (!EQ (*vecp++, frame)) | |
6265 goto changed; | |
6266 if (!EQ (*vecp++, XFRAME (frame)->name)) | |
6267 goto changed; | |
6268 } | |
6269 /* Check that the buffer info matches. | |
6270 No need to test for the end of the vector | |
6271 because the last element of the vector is lambda | |
6272 and that will always cause a mismatch. */ | |
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6273 for (tail = Vbuffer_alist; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail)) |
25012 | 6274 { |
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6275 buf = XCDR (XCAR (tail)); |
25012 | 6276 /* Ignore buffers that aren't included in buffer lists. */ |
6277 if (XSTRING (XBUFFER (buf)->name)->data[0] == ' ') | |
6278 continue; | |
6279 if (!EQ (*vecp++, buf)) | |
6280 goto changed; | |
6281 if (!EQ (*vecp++, XBUFFER (buf)->read_only)) | |
6282 goto changed; | |
6283 if (!EQ (*vecp++, Fbuffer_modified_p (buf))) | |
6284 goto changed; | |
6285 } | |
6286 /* Detect deletion of a buffer at the end of the list. */ | |
6287 if (EQ (*vecp, Qlambda)) | |
6288 return Qnil; | |
6289 changed: | |
6290 /* Start with 1 so there is room for at least one lambda at the end. */ | |
6291 n = 1; | |
6292 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
6293 n += 2; | |
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6294 for (tail = Vbuffer_alist; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail)) |
25012 | 6295 n += 3; |
6296 /* Reallocate the vector if it's grown, or if it's shrunk a lot. */ | |
6297 if (n > XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->size | |
6298 || n + 20 < XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->size / 2) | |
6299 /* Add 20 extra so we grow it less often. */ | |
6300 frame_and_buffer_state = Fmake_vector (make_number (n + 20), Qlambda); | |
6301 vecp = XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->contents; | |
6302 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
6303 { | |
6304 *vecp++ = frame; | |
6305 *vecp++ = XFRAME (frame)->name; | |
6306 } | |
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6307 for (tail = Vbuffer_alist; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail)) |
25012 | 6308 { |
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6309 buf = XCDR (XCAR (tail)); |
25012 | 6310 /* Ignore buffers that aren't included in buffer lists. */ |
6311 if (XSTRING (XBUFFER (buf)->name)->data[0] == ' ') | |
6312 continue; | |
6313 *vecp++ = buf; | |
6314 *vecp++ = XBUFFER (buf)->read_only; | |
6315 *vecp++ = Fbuffer_modified_p (buf); | |
6316 } | |
6317 /* Fill up the vector with lambdas (always at least one). */ | |
6318 *vecp++ = Qlambda; | |
6319 while (vecp - XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->contents | |
6320 < XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->size) | |
6321 *vecp++ = Qlambda; | |
6322 /* Make sure we didn't overflow the vector. */ | |
6323 if (vecp - XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->contents | |
6324 > XVECTOR (frame_and_buffer_state)->size) | |
6325 abort (); | |
6326 return Qt; | |
6327 } | |
6328 | |
6329 | |
6330 | |
6331 /*********************************************************************** | |
6332 Initialization | |
6333 ***********************************************************************/ | |
6334 | |
314 | 6335 char *terminal_type; |
6336 | |
25012 | 6337 /* Initialization done when Emacs fork is started, before doing stty. |
6338 Determine terminal type and set terminal_driver. Then invoke its | |
6339 decoding routine to set up variables in the terminal package. */ | |
314 | 6340 |
21514 | 6341 void |
314 | 6342 init_display () |
6343 { | |
6344 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS | |
6345 extern int display_arg; | |
6346 #endif | |
6347 | |
25012 | 6348 /* Construct the space glyph. */ |
6349 space_glyph.type = CHAR_GLYPH; | |
6350 SET_CHAR_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH (space_glyph, ' '); | |
6351 space_glyph.charpos = -1; | |
6352 | |
314 | 6353 meta_key = 0; |
6354 inverse_video = 0; | |
6355 cursor_in_echo_area = 0; | |
6356 terminal_type = (char *) 0; | |
6357 | |
2339
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6358 /* Now is the time to initialize this; it's used by init_sys_modes |
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6359 during startup. */ |
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6360 Vwindow_system = Qnil; |
314 | 6361 |
2339
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6362 /* If the user wants to use a window system, we shouldn't bother |
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6363 initializing the terminal. This is especially important when the |
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6364 terminal is so dumb that emacs gives up before and doesn't bother |
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6365 using the window system. |
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6366 |
14125
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6367 If the DISPLAY environment variable is set and nonempty, |
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6368 try to use X, and die with an error message if that doesn't work. */ |
314 | 6369 |
6370 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS | |
2359
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6371 if (! display_arg) |
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6372 { |
14125
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6373 char *display; |
2359
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6374 #ifdef VMS |
14125
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6375 display = getenv ("DECW$DISPLAY"); |
2359
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6376 #else |
14125
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6377 display = getenv ("DISPLAY"); |
2359
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6378 #endif |
14125
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6379 |
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6380 display_arg = (display != 0 && *display != 0); |
2364 | 6381 } |
2359
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6382 |
18774
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6383 if (!inhibit_window_system && display_arg |
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6384 #ifndef CANNOT_DUMP |
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6385 && initialized |
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6386 #endif |
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6387 ) |
314 | 6388 { |
6389 Vwindow_system = intern ("x"); | |
6390 #ifdef HAVE_X11 | |
6391 Vwindow_system_version = make_number (11); | |
6392 #else | |
6393 Vwindow_system_version = make_number (10); | |
6394 #endif | |
15273
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6395 #if defined (LINUX) && defined (HAVE_LIBNCURSES) |
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6396 /* In some versions of ncurses, |
15282 | 6397 tputs crashes if we have not called tgetent. |
15273
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6398 So call tgetent. */ |
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6399 { char b[2044]; tgetent (b, "xterm");} |
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6400 #endif |
25012 | 6401 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (); |
314 | 6402 return; |
6403 } | |
6404 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */ | |
6405 | |
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6406 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6407 if (!inhibit_window_system) |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6408 { |
16589
ec300a10e407
(init_display) [HAVE_NTGUI]: Use w32 for window-system.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
16412
diff
changeset
|
6409 Vwindow_system = intern ("w32"); |
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6410 Vwindow_system_version = make_number (1); |
25012 | 6411 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (); |
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6412 return; |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6413 } |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6414 #endif /* HAVE_NTGUI */ |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6415 |
32752
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6416 #ifdef macintosh |
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6417 if (!inhibit_window_system) |
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6418 { |
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6419 Vwindow_system = intern ("mac"); |
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6420 Vwindow_system_version = make_number (1); |
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6421 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (); |
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6422 return; |
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6423 } |
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6424 #endif /* macintosh */ |
923b8d6d8277
Initial check-in: changes for building Emacs under Mac OS.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents:
32468
diff
changeset
|
6425 |
314 | 6426 /* If no window system has been specified, try to use the terminal. */ |
6427 if (! isatty (0)) | |
6428 { | |
16896
b2c51d6de440
(init_display): Use `fatal'.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16891
diff
changeset
|
6429 fatal ("standard input is not a tty"); |
314 | 6430 exit (1); |
6431 } | |
6432 | |
6433 /* Look at the TERM variable */ | |
6434 terminal_type = (char *) getenv ("TERM"); | |
6435 if (!terminal_type) | |
6436 { | |
6437 #ifdef VMS | |
6438 fprintf (stderr, "Please specify your terminal type.\n\ | |
6439 For types defined in VMS, use set term /device=TYPE.\n\ | |
6440 For types not defined in VMS, use define emacs_term \"TYPE\".\n\ | |
6441 \(The quotation marks are necessary since terminal types are lower case.)\n"); | |
6442 #else | |
6443 fprintf (stderr, "Please set the environment variable TERM; see tset(1).\n"); | |
6444 #endif | |
6445 exit (1); | |
6446 } | |
6447 | |
6448 #ifdef VMS | |
25012 | 6449 /* VMS DCL tends to up-case things, so down-case term type. |
314 | 6450 Hardly any uppercase letters in terminal types; should be none. */ |
6451 { | |
6452 char *new = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (terminal_type) + 1); | |
6453 char *p; | |
6454 | |
6455 strcpy (new, terminal_type); | |
6456 | |
6457 for (p = new; *p; p++) | |
6458 if (isupper (*p)) | |
6459 *p = tolower (*p); | |
6460 | |
6461 terminal_type = new; | |
6462 } | |
25012 | 6463 #endif /* VMS */ |
314 | 6464 |
6465 term_init (terminal_type); | |
25012 | 6466 |
16891
989845750a4d
(init_display): Check for overflow in screen size.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16881
diff
changeset
|
6467 { |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
6468 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME (); |
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
6469 int width = FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (sf); |
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
6470 int height = FRAME_HEIGHT (sf); |
16891
989845750a4d
(init_display): Check for overflow in screen size.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16881
diff
changeset
|
6471 |
25012 | 6472 unsigned int total_glyphs = height * (width + 2) * sizeof (struct glyph); |
6473 | |
6474 /* If these sizes are so big they cause overflow, just ignore the | |
6475 change. It's not clear what better we could do. */ | |
6476 if (total_glyphs / sizeof (struct glyph) / height != width + 2) | |
16896
b2c51d6de440
(init_display): Use `fatal'.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16891
diff
changeset
|
6477 fatal ("screen size %dx%d too big", width, height); |
16891
989845750a4d
(init_display): Check for overflow in screen size.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16881
diff
changeset
|
6478 } |
989845750a4d
(init_display): Check for overflow in screen size.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16881
diff
changeset
|
6479 |
25012 | 6480 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (); |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
6481 calculate_costs (XFRAME (selected_frame)); |
314 | 6482 |
6483 #ifdef SIGWINCH | |
6484 #ifndef CANNOT_DUMP | |
6485 if (initialized) | |
6486 #endif /* CANNOT_DUMP */ | |
6487 signal (SIGWINCH, window_change_signal); | |
6488 #endif /* SIGWINCH */ | |
25012 | 6489 |
6490 /* Set up faces of the initial terminal frame of a dumped Emacs. */ | |
6491 if (initialized | |
6492 && !noninteractive | |
25118
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6493 #ifdef MSDOS |
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6494 /* The MSDOS terminal turns on its ``window system'' relatively |
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6495 late into the startup, so we cannot do the frame faces' |
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6496 initialization just yet. It will be done later by pc-win.el |
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6497 and internal_terminal_init. */ |
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6498 && (strcmp (terminal_type, "internal") != 0 || inhibit_window_system) |
08ae9ffe6763
(init_display) [MSDOS]: Don't initialize frame faces,
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
25012
diff
changeset
|
6499 #endif |
25012 | 6500 && NILP (Vwindow_system)) |
26729
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6501 { |
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6502 /* For the initial frame, we don't have any way of knowing what |
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6503 are the foreground and background colors of the terminal. */ |
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6504 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME(); |
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6505 |
26902
264b83a3a688
Changes for separate unspecified foreground and background colors
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26851
diff
changeset
|
6506 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (sf) = FACE_TTY_DEFAULT_FG_COLOR; |
264b83a3a688
Changes for separate unspecified foreground and background colors
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26851
diff
changeset
|
6507 FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (sf) = FACE_TTY_DEFAULT_BG_COLOR; |
26729
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6508 call0 (intern ("tty-set-up-initial-frame-faces")); |
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6509 } |
314 | 6510 } |
25012 | 6511 |
6512 | |
314 | 6513 |
25012 | 6514 /*********************************************************************** |
6515 Blinking cursor | |
6516 ***********************************************************************/ | |
6517 | |
26280
083835afced5
(Finternal_show_cursor): Renamed from Fshow_cursor.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26164
diff
changeset
|
6518 DEFUN ("internal-show-cursor", Finternal_show_cursor, |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6519 Sinternal_show_cursor, 2, 2, 0, |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6520 "Set the cursor-visibility flag of WINDOW to SHOW.\n\ |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6521 WINDOW nil means use the selected window. SHOW non-nil means\n\ |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6522 show a cursor in WINDOW in the next redisplay. SHOW nil means\n\ |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6523 don't show a cursor.") |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6524 (window, show) |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6525 Lisp_Object window, show; |
25012 | 6526 { |
6527 /* Don't change cursor state while redisplaying. This could confuse | |
6528 output routines. */ | |
6529 if (!redisplaying_p) | |
6530 { | |
6531 if (NILP (window)) | |
6532 window = selected_window; | |
6533 else | |
6534 CHECK_WINDOW (window, 2); | |
6535 | |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6536 XWINDOW (window)->cursor_off_p = NILP (show); |
25012 | 6537 } |
6538 | |
6539 return Qnil; | |
6540 } | |
6541 | |
6542 | |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6543 DEFUN ("internal-show-cursor-p", Finternal_show_cursor_p, |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6544 Sinternal_show_cursor_p, 0, 1, 0, |
26499
10af169a628b
(Finternal_show_cursor_p): Fix doc string.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26334
diff
changeset
|
6545 "Value is non-nil if next redisplay will display a cursor in WINDOW.\n\ |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6546 WINDOW nil or omitted means report on the selected window.") |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6547 (window) |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6548 Lisp_Object window; |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6549 { |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6550 struct window *w; |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6551 |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6552 if (NILP (window)) |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6553 window = selected_window; |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6554 else |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6555 CHECK_WINDOW (window, 2); |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6556 |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6557 w = XWINDOW (window); |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6558 return w->cursor_off_p ? Qnil : Qt; |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6559 } |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6560 |
25012 | 6561 |
6562 /*********************************************************************** | |
6563 Initialization | |
6564 ***********************************************************************/ | |
6565 | |
21514 | 6566 void |
314 | 6567 syms_of_display () |
6568 { | |
764 | 6569 defsubr (&Sredraw_frame); |
314 | 6570 defsubr (&Sredraw_display); |
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
6571 defsubr (&Sframe_or_buffer_changed_p); |
314 | 6572 defsubr (&Sopen_termscript); |
6573 defsubr (&Sding); | |
6574 defsubr (&Ssit_for); | |
6575 defsubr (&Ssleep_for); | |
6576 defsubr (&Ssend_string_to_terminal); | |
26280
083835afced5
(Finternal_show_cursor): Renamed from Fshow_cursor.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26164
diff
changeset
|
6577 defsubr (&Sinternal_show_cursor); |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6578 defsubr (&Sinternal_show_cursor_p); |
314 | 6579 |
34893
779bd3fa820e
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34866
diff
changeset
|
6580 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
6581 defsubr (&Sdump_redisplay_history); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
6582 #endif |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
6583 |
12186
6811992e871c
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Calculate vector size right.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
11919
diff
changeset
|
6584 frame_and_buffer_state = Fmake_vector (make_number (20), Qlambda); |
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
6585 staticpro (&frame_and_buffer_state); |
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
6586 |
13220
2e9014617492
(Qdisplay_table): New variable.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13105
diff
changeset
|
6587 Qdisplay_table = intern ("display-table"); |
2e9014617492
(Qdisplay_table): New variable.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13105
diff
changeset
|
6588 staticpro (&Qdisplay_table); |
30720
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
6589 Qredisplay_dont_pause = intern ("redisplay-dont-pause"); |
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
6590 staticpro (&Qredisplay_dont_pause); |
13220
2e9014617492
(Qdisplay_table): New variable.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13105
diff
changeset
|
6591 |
314 | 6592 DEFVAR_INT ("baud-rate", &baud_rate, |
7926
b87f2c705501
(syms_of_display): Make baud-rate a user var.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7900
diff
changeset
|
6593 "*The output baud rate of the terminal.\n\ |
314 | 6594 On most systems, changing this value will affect the amount of padding\n\ |
6595 and the other strategic decisions made during redisplay."); | |
25012 | 6596 |
314 | 6597 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inverse-video", &inverse_video, |
764 | 6598 "*Non-nil means invert the entire frame display.\n\ |
314 | 6599 This means everything is in inverse video which otherwise would not be."); |
25012 | 6600 |
314 | 6601 DEFVAR_BOOL ("visible-bell", &visible_bell, |
764 | 6602 "*Non-nil means try to flash the frame to represent a bell."); |
25012 | 6603 |
314 | 6604 DEFVAR_BOOL ("no-redraw-on-reenter", &no_redraw_on_reenter, |
764 | 6605 "*Non-nil means no need to redraw entire frame after suspending.\n\ |
314 | 6606 A non-nil value is useful if the terminal can automatically preserve\n\ |
764 | 6607 Emacs's frame display when you reenter Emacs.\n\ |
314 | 6608 It is up to you to set this variable if your terminal can do that."); |
25012 | 6609 |
314 | 6610 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-system", &Vwindow_system, |
6611 "A symbol naming the window-system under which Emacs is running\n\ | |
6612 \(such as `x'), or nil if emacs is running on an ordinary terminal."); | |
25012 | 6613 |
314 | 6614 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-system-version", &Vwindow_system_version, |
6615 "The version number of the window system in use.\n\ | |
6616 For X windows, this is 10 or 11."); | |
25012 | 6617 |
314 | 6618 DEFVAR_BOOL ("cursor-in-echo-area", &cursor_in_echo_area, |
6619 "Non-nil means put cursor in minibuffer, at end of any message there."); | |
25012 | 6620 |
314 | 6621 DEFVAR_LISP ("glyph-table", &Vglyph_table, |
764 | 6622 "Table defining how to output a glyph code to the frame.\n\ |
314 | 6623 If not nil, this is a vector indexed by glyph code to define the glyph.\n\ |
6624 Each element can be:\n\ | |
6625 integer: a glyph code which this glyph is an alias for.\n\ | |
6626 string: output this glyph using that string (not impl. in X windows).\n\ | |
6627 nil: this glyph mod 256 is char code to output,\n\ | |
6857 | 6628 and this glyph / 256 is face code for X windows (see `face-id')."); |
314 | 6629 Vglyph_table = Qnil; |
6630 | |
6631 DEFVAR_LISP ("standard-display-table", &Vstandard_display_table, | |
6632 "Display table to use for buffers that specify none.\n\ | |
6633 See `buffer-display-table' for more information."); | |
6634 Vstandard_display_table = Qnil; | |
6635 | |
25012 | 6636 DEFVAR_BOOL ("redisplay-dont-pause", &redisplay_dont_pause, |
6637 "*Non-nil means update isn't paused when input is detected."); | |
6638 redisplay_dont_pause = 0; | |
6639 | |
314 | 6640 /* Initialize `window-system', unless init_display already decided it. */ |
6641 #ifdef CANNOT_DUMP | |
6642 if (noninteractive) | |
6643 #endif | |
6644 { | |
6645 Vwindow_system = Qnil; | |
6646 Vwindow_system_version = Qnil; | |
6647 } | |
6648 } |